1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@syncodeindex ky cp
5@c man begin INCLUDE
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8@include bfdver.texi
9@c man end
10
11@c @smallbook
12
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
22@set ARM
23@set C6X
24@set CSKY
25@set H8300
26@set HPPA
27@set M68HC11
28@set M68K
29@set MIPS
30@set MMIX
31@set MSP430
32@set NDS32
33@set NIOSII
34@set PDP11
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
37@set Renesas
38@set S/390
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
41@set WIN32
42@set XTENSA
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
49* Ld: (ld).                       The GNU linker.
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
52
53@copying
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
59
60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts.  A copy of the license is included in the
67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68@end copying
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
72@settitle The GNU linker
73@titlepage
74@title The GNU linker
75@sp 1
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts.  A copy of the license is included in the
104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105@c man end
106
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
109@contents
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112@ifnottex
113@node Top
114@top LD
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
120
121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122Documentation License version 1.3.  A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125@menu
126* Overview::                    Overview
127* Invocation::                  Invocation
128* Scripts::                     Linker Scripts
129* Plugins::                     Linker Plugins
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent::           Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300::                      ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas::                     ld and other Renesas micros
139@end ifset
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM::				ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12::              ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32::                  ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K::                        ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS::                        ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32::               ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64::             ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF::			ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF::			ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF::                     ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32::                       ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa::                      ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD::                         BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs::              Reporting Bugs
183* MRI::                         MRI Compatible Script Files
184* GNU Free Documentation License::  GNU Free Documentation License
185* LD Index::                       LD Index
186@end menu
187@end ifnottex
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
194
195@ifset man
196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222@end ifset
223
224@ifclear SingleFormat
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}.  Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file.  @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information.  Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238@c man end
239
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers.  As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249@c man end
250
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
253* Options::                     Command-line Options
254* Environment::                 Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
258@section Command-line Options
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system.  On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories.  (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283point in the command line.  However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options.  Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option.  Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together.  They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language.  If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305assume that it is a linker script.  A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}).  This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects.  Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command.  @xref{Scripts}.
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent.  Note---there is one exception to
324this rule.  Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325only be preceded by two dashes.  This is to reduce confusion with the
326@samp{-o} option.  So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them.  For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
336
337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
341
342@smallexample
343  gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link.  Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler.  In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355  gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
357
358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359linker:
360
361@table @gcctabopt
362@include at-file.texi
363
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility.  The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}.  @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}.  This option may be used any number of times.
371
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library.  If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381interface.
382
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file.  If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394that follow this option on the command line.  Even when @command{ld} is
395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries.  (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format.  You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407particular format.
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
444@item -d
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers.  They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}).  The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library.  If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use.  This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough.  This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one.  The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475  MEMORY @{
476    MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477    MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478    MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479  @}
480  SECTIONS @{
481    mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482    mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483    mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484  @}
485
486  with input sections:
487  .data.1: size 8
488  .data.2: size 0x10
489  .data.3: size 4
490
491  results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492  affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
509@item -e @var{entry}
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point.  If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8).  @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
522exported.  The library names may be delimited by commas or colons.  Specifying
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export.  This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports.  For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option.  For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link.  The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line.  This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker.  Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table.  The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
568
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports.  PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name.  See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
591@ifclear SingleFormat
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects.  This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects.  This affects the default output format.
602@end ifclear
603
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name.  This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field.  If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}.  If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object.  The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
621machine-specific performance.
622
623This option may be specified more than once.  The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
628@item -F @var{name}
629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name.  This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field.  The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}.  Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
654
655@cindex finalization function
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function.  By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored.  Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
669@cindex object size
670@item -G @var{value}
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}.  This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
675sections.  This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
678@kindex -h @var{name}
679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
680@item -h @var{name}
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name.  When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
693@cindex initialization function
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function.  By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
704@item -l @var{namespec}
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link.  This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
711
712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.  Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.  (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.)  Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line.  If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive.  However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers.  However,
735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
740@kindex -L @var{dir}
741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
742@item -L @var{searchdir}
743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts.  You may use this
746option any number of times.  The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line.  Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories.  All
749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
750order in which the options appear.  @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
753
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
757
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
761some cases also on how it was configured.  @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command.  Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
770@item -m @var{emulation}
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker.  You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output.  A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
790Where object files are mapped into memory.
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map.  This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression.  Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets.  Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808   foo = 1
809   foo = foo * 4
810   foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817   0x00000001                foo = 0x1
818   [0x0000000c]                foo = (foo * 0x4)
819   [0x0000000c]                foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
824
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
827
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map.  For example:
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
837merging properties in  @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
842@end smallexample
843
844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
845when merging properties in  @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
847@end itemize
848
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map.  Enabled by default.
856
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries.  If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
871@item -N
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable.  Also, do
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries.  If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option.  It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned.  Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries.  Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default.  The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}.  This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it.  The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}).  Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler).  So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
916the output.  This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
917should only be enabled for the final binary.  At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation.  Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option.  Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option.  Again this may change with future releases.
922
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process.  The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin.  Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins.  In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory.  All gcc
936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
937just copy in the newest one.
938
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}.  When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time.  It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
964@item --pop-state
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables.  This results
976in larger executables.
977
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections.  This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
989@kindex --relocatable
990@item -r
991@itemx --relocatable
992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
993turn serve as input to @command{ld}.  This is often called @dfn{partial
994linking}.  As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
997@c ; see @option{-N}.
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced.  When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations.  Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output.  This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs.  You may use this option more than once.
1019
1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1022the @option{-rpath} option.
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
1027@item -s
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
1034@item -S
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
1048@item -t
1049@itemx --trace
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them.  If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script.  This script replaces
1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1064output file.  @xref{Scripts}.  If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options.  Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
1068
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script.  @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed.  This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user.  (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol.  Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries.  @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols.  This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file.  This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit.  The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together.  This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
1114@item -Ur
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}.  When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to.  Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled.  An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script.  @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}.  The option
1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section.  An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script.  You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line;  It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
1162
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
1170Display the version number for @command{ld}.  The @option{-V} option also
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
1183@item -X
1184@itemx --discard-locals
1185Delete all temporary local symbols.  (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears.  This
1195option may be given any number of times.  On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path.  This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section.  @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files.  @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
1241@item combreloc
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching.  Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1245
1246@item common
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link.  Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}.  Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
1255
1256@item defs
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files.  This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1260
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning.  Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}.  If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic.  Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.  It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag.  Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1286
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
1291@item ibt
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT.  This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
1296@item indirect-extern-access
1297@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1298Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1299.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1300canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1301This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1302@option{nocopyreloc}.  Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1303
1304@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1305GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1306section.
1307
1308@item initfirst
1309This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1310It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1311before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1312the process at the same time.  Similarly the runtime finalization of
1313the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1314objects.
1315
1316@item interpose
1317Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1318so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1319libraries not so marked.
1320
1321@item unique
1322@itemx nounique
1323When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1324object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1325and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1326primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1327al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1328of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1329and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1330
1331@item lam-u48
1332Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1333to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48.  Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1334
1335@item lam-u57
1336Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1337to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57.  Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u48-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files.  @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-u57-report=none
1352@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1355property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1356@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files.  @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1360make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363@item lam-report=none
1364@itemx lam-report=warning
1365@itemx lam-report=error
1366Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1367GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1368section.  @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1369linker not report missing properties in input files.
1370@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1371missing properties in input files.  @option{lam-report=error} will make
1372the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1373Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1374
1375@item lazy
1376When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1377dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1378the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1379Lazy binding is the default.
1380
1381@item loadfltr
1382Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1383
1384@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1385Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1386
1387@item muldefs
1388Allow multiple definitions.
1389
1390@item nocopyreloc
1391Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1392defined in shared libraries.  May result in dynamic text relocations.
1393
1394@item nodefaultlib
1395Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1396should ignore any default library search paths.
1397
1398@item nodelete
1399Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1400
1401@item nodlopen
1402Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1403
1404@item nodump
1405Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1406
1407@item noexecstack
1408Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1409
1410@item noextern-protected-data
1411Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1412library.  This option overrides the linker backend default.  It can be
1413used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1414generated by compiler.  Updates on protected data symbols by another
1415module aren't visible to the resulting shared library.  Supported for
1416i386 and x86-64.
1417
1418@item noreloc-overflow
1419Disable relocation overflow check.  This can be used to disable
1420relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1421overflow at run-time.  Supported for x86_64.
1422
1423@item now
1424When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1425dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1426when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1427function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1428called.
1429
1430@item origin
1431Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1432
1433@item pack-relative-relocs
1434@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1435Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1436and shared library.  It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1437@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section.  It is ignored when
1438building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1439@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1440relative relocation.  When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1441GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1442added to the output.  Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1443
1444@item relro
1445@itemx norelro
1446Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object.  This
1447specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1448relocation, if supported.  Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1449than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1450Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1451
1452@item report-relative-reloc
1453Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker.  Supported for
1454Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1455
1456@item separate-code
1457@itemx noseparate-code
1458Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object.  This
1459specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1460be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data.  Don't create separate
1461code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1462
1463@item shstk
1464Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1465to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack.  Supported for
1466Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1467
1468@item stack-size=@var{value}
1469Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1470Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1471@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1472
1473@item start-stop-gc
1474@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1475@cindex start-stop-gc
1476When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1477section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1478input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1479@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1480@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1481linker.  @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1482sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1483were not defined.  @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1484definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1485object file or linker script.  Such a definition will prevent the
1486linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1487@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1488treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1489
1490@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1491@cindex visibility
1492@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1493Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1494@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1495Section Example}).  @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1496@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}.  If no @samp{-z
1497start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1498compatibility with historical practice.  However, it's highly
1499recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1500programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1501between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1502
1503@item text
1504@itemx notext
1505@itemx textoff
1506Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1507or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections.  Don't
1508report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1509
1510@item undefs
1511Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1512either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1513This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1514
1515@item unique-symbol
1516@itemx nounique-symbol
1517Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table.  Append
1518".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1519is used.  @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1520
1521@item x86-64-baseline
1522@item x86-64-v2
1523@item x86-64-v3
1524@itemx x86-64-v4
1525Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1526@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1527@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1528@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1529@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1530Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1531
1532@end table
1533
1534Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1535
1536@kindex -(
1537@cindex groups of archives
1538@item -( @var{archives} -)
1539@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1540The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files.  They may be
1541either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1542
1543The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1544references are created.  Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1545the order that it is specified on the command line.  If a symbol in that
1546archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1547object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1548would not be able to resolve that reference.  By grouping the archives,
1549they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1550resolved.
1551
1552Using this option has a significant performance cost.  It is best to use
1553it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1554more archives.
1555
1556@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1557@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1558@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1559@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1560Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1561recognised.  The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1562and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files.  This was
1563the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14.  The default
1564behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1565so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1566restore the old behaviour.
1567
1568@kindex --as-needed
1569@kindex --no-as-needed
1570@item --as-needed
1571@itemx --no-as-needed
1572This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1573on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option.  Normally
1574the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1575on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1576needed or not.  @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1577emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1578non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1579the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1580non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1581Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1582the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1583needed.  This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1584from archives.  @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1585
1586Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1587an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1588@option{--rpath-link} options.  See the description of
1589@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1590
1591@kindex --add-needed
1592@kindex --no-add-needed
1593@item --add-needed
1594@itemx --no-add-needed
1595These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1596their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1597options.  They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1598and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1599
1600@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1601@item -assert @var{keyword}
1602This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1603
1604@kindex -Bdynamic
1605@kindex -dy
1606@kindex -call_shared
1607@item -Bdynamic
1608@itemx -dy
1609@itemx -call_shared
1610Link against dynamic libraries.  This is only meaningful on platforms
1611for which shared libraries are supported.  This option is normally the
1612default on such platforms.  The different variants of this option are
1613for compatibility with various systems.  You may use this option
1614multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1615@option{-l} options which follow it.
1616
1617@kindex -Bgroup
1618@item -Bgroup
1619Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1620section.  This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1621object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1622@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied.  This option is
1623only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1624
1625@kindex -Bstatic
1626@kindex -dn
1627@kindex -non_shared
1628@kindex -static
1629@item -Bstatic
1630@itemx -dn
1631@itemx -non_shared
1632@itemx -static
1633Do not link against shared libraries.  This is only meaningful on
1634platforms for which shared libraries are supported.  The different
1635variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems.  You
1636may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1637library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it.  This
1638option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}.  This
1639option can be used with @option{-shared}.  Doing so means that a
1640shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1641references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1642libraries.
1643
1644@kindex -Bsymbolic
1645@item -Bsymbolic
1646When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1647definition within the shared library, if any.  Normally, it is possible
1648for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1649within the shared library.  This option is only meaningful on ELF
1650platforms which support shared libraries.
1651
1652@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1653@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1654When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1655symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1656This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1657libraries.
1658
1659@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1660@item -Bno-symbolic
1661This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1662@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1663
1664@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1665@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1666Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker.  This is
1667typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1668global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1669within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1670to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1671in the executable.  This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1672which support shared libraries.
1673
1674The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1675scope and node name.  See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1676
1677@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1678@item --dynamic-list-data
1679Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1680
1681@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1682@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1683Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete.  It
1684is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1685
1686@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1687@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1688Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1689
1690@kindex --check-sections
1691@kindex --no-check-sections
1692@item --check-sections
1693@itemx --no-check-sections
1694Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1695been assigned to see if there are any overlaps.  Normally the linker will
1696perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1697suitable error messages.  The linker does know about, and does make
1698allowances for sections in overlays.  The default behaviour can be
1699restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1700Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links.  You can
1701force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1702option.
1703
1704@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1705@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1706@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1707@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1708This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1709by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1710command line.  Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1711output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1712input dynamic library.  With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1713specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1714follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added.  The default
1715behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1716
1717This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1718libraries.  With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1719mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1720their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1721required by the output binary.  With the default setting however
1722the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1723dynamic library itself.  No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1724symbols.
1725
1726@cindex cross reference table
1727@kindex --cref
1728@item --cref
1729Output a cross reference table.  If a linker map file is being
1730generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1731Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1732
1733The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1734easily processed by a script if necessary.  The symbols are printed out,
1735sorted by name.  For each symbol, a list of file names is given.  If the
1736symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1737definition.  If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1738where this happens appear next.  Finally any files that reference the
1739symbol are listed.
1740
1741@cindex ctf variables
1742@kindex --ctf-variables
1743@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1744@item --ctf-variables
1745@item --no-ctf-variables
1746The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1747types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1748table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1749conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1750usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1751@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1752The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1753
1754@cindex ctf type sharing
1755@kindex --ctf-share-types
1756@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1757Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1758
1759@table @samp
1760@item share-unconflicted
1761Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1762where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1763translation unit.  This is the default.
1764
1765@item share-duplicated
1766Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1767dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1768dictionaries.  Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1769always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries.  This tends to make the CTF
1770larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary.  For very
1771large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1772consumer at runtime.
1773@end table
1774
1775@cindex common allocation
1776@kindex --no-define-common
1777@item --no-define-common
1778This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1779The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1780@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1781
1782The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1783the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1784of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1785forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1786Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1787from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1788This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1789and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1790duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1791paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1792
1793@cindex group allocation in linker script
1794@cindex section groups
1795@cindex COMDAT
1796@kindex --force-group-allocation
1797@item --force-group-allocation
1798This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1799normal input sections, and to delete the section groups.  This is the
1800default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1801change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}).  The script
1802command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1803effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1804
1805@cindex symbols, from command line
1806@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1807@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1808Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1809address given by @var{expression}.  You may use this option as many
1810times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line.  A
1811limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1812context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1813symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1814constants or symbols.  If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1815using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1816@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1817equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1818
1819The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1820in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1821symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1822placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1823the linker script has been processed.  This difference has
1824consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1825@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1826you are trying to achieve.
1827
1828@cindex demangling, from command line
1829@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1830@kindex --no-demangle
1831@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1832@itemx --no-demangle
1833These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1834and other output.  When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1835present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1836underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1837mangled symbol names into user readable names.  Different compilers have
1838different mangling styles.  The optional demangling style argument can be used
1839to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler.  The linker will
1840demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1841is set.  These options may be used to override the default.
1842
1843@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1844@kindex -I@var{file}
1845@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1846@item -I@var{file}
1847@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1848Set the name of the dynamic linker.  This is only meaningful when
1849generating dynamically linked ELF executables.  The default dynamic
1850linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1851doing.
1852
1853@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1854@item --no-dynamic-linker
1855When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1856linker to be used at load-time.  This is only meaningful for ELF
1857executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1858entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1859
1860@kindex --embedded-relocs
1861@item --embedded-relocs
1862This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1863that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section.  This option
1864is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1865targets.
1866
1867@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1868@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1869Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1870in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1871
1872@kindex --fatal-warnings
1873@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1874@item --fatal-warnings
1875@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1876Treat all warnings as errors.  The default behaviour can be restored
1877with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1878
1879@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1880@item  --force-exe-suffix
1881Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1882
1883If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1884@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1885the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1886option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1887Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1888it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1889
1890@kindex --gc-sections
1891@kindex --no-gc-sections
1892@cindex garbage collection
1893@item --gc-sections
1894@itemx --no-gc-sections
1895Enable garbage collection of unused input sections.  It is ignored on
1896targets that do not support this option.  The default behaviour (of not
1897performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1898@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line.  Note that garbage
1899collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1900implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1901
1902@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1903examining symbols and relocations.  The section containing the entry
1904symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1905command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1906referenced by dynamic objects.  Note that when building shared
1907libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1908referenced.  Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1909the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1910relocations.  See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1911@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1912
1913This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1914@samp{-r}).  In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1915specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1916@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1917command in the linker script.
1918
1919As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1920@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1921
1922@kindex --print-gc-sections
1923@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1924@cindex garbage collection
1925@item --print-gc-sections
1926@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1927List all sections removed by garbage collection.  The listing is
1928printed on stderr.  This option is only effective if garbage
1929collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option.  The
1930default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1931be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1932line.
1933
1934@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1935@cindex garbage collection
1936@item --gc-keep-exported
1937When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1938collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1939default or protected visibility.  This option is intended to be used for
1940executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1941collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1942Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1943it is already the default behaviour.  This option is only supported for
1944ELF format targets.
1945
1946@kindex --print-output-format
1947@cindex output format
1948@item --print-output-format
1949Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1950other command-line options).  This is the string that would appear
1951in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1952
1953@kindex --print-memory-usage
1954@cindex memory usage
1955@item --print-memory-usage
1956Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1957the @ref{MEMORY} command.  This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1958quick view of amount of free memory.  The format of the output has one
1959headline and one line per region.  It is both human readable and easily
1960parsable by tools.  Here is an example of an output:
1961
1962@smallexample
1963Memory region         Used Size  Region Size  %age Used
1964             ROM:        256 KB         1 MB     25.00%
1965             RAM:          32 B         2 GB      0.00%
1966@end smallexample
1967
1968@cindex help
1969@cindex usage
1970@kindex --help
1971@item --help
1972Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1973
1974@kindex --target-help
1975@item --target-help
1976Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1977
1978@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1979@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1980Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}.  See the description of the
1981@option{-M} option, above.  If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1982@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1983
1984Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1985written as a file inside the directory.  Normally name of the file
1986inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1987file with @code{.map} appended.   If however the special character
1988@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1989output file.  Additionally if there are any characters after the
1990@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1991
1992@smallexample
1993 -o foo.exe -Map=bar                  [Creates ./bar]
1994 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar           [Creates ./bar]
1995 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir               [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1996 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir       [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1997 -o foo.exe -Map=%                    [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1998 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%             [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1999 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar                [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2000 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar         [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2001 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%     [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2002 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2003@end smallexample
2004
2005It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2006
2007If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2008operation.
2009
2010@cindex memory usage
2011@kindex --no-keep-memory
2012@item --no-keep-memory
2013@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2014symbol tables of input files in memory.  This option tells @command{ld} to
2015instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2016necessary.  This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2017while linking a large executable.
2018
2019@kindex --no-undefined
2020@kindex -z defs
2021@kindex -z undefs
2022@item --no-undefined
2023@itemx -z defs
2024Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files.  This
2025is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2026The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2027behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2028libraries being linked in.
2029
2030The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2031
2032@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2033@kindex -z muldefs
2034@item --allow-multiple-definition
2035@itemx -z muldefs
2036Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2037report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2038first definition will be used.
2039
2040@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2041@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2042@item --allow-shlib-undefined
2043@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2044Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2045This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2046determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2047shared library rather than a regular object file.  It does not affect
2048how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2049
2050The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2051referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2052an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2053a shared library.
2054
2055The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2056libraries specified at link time are that:
2057
2058@itemize @bullet
2059@item
2060A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2061that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2062resolvable at load time.
2063@item
2064There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2065symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2066
2067The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2068select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2069architecture.  This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2070appropriate memset function.
2071@end itemize
2072
2073@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2074@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2075If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2076@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered.  Currently however
2077only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2078libraries.  Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2079``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2080undefined symbol or missing library.  The intention is that the script
2081will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2082might be found.  After the script has finished then the normal linker
2083error message will be displayed.
2084
2085The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2086switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2087
2088@kindex --no-undefined-version
2089@item --no-undefined-version
2090Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2091it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2092will be issued instead.
2093
2094@kindex --default-symver
2095@item --default-symver
2096Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2097exported symbols.
2098
2099@kindex --default-imported-symver
2100@item --default-imported-symver
2101Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2102imported symbols.
2103
2104@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2105@item --no-warn-mismatch
2106Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2107files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2108been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2109This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2110errors.  This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2111have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2112inappropriate.
2113
2114@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2115@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2116Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2117library during a library search.  This option silences the warning.
2118
2119@kindex --no-whole-archive
2120@item --no-whole-archive
2121Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2122archive files.
2123
2124@cindex output file after errors
2125@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2126@item --noinhibit-exec
2127Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2128Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2129errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2130when it issues any error whatsoever.
2131
2132@kindex -nostdlib
2133@item -nostdlib
2134Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2135command line.  Library directories specified in linker scripts
2136(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2137
2138@ifclear SingleFormat
2139@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2140@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2141@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2142file.  If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2143@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2144object file.  Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2145object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2146should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2147usual format on each machine.  @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2148name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries.  (You can
2149list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)  The script
2150command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2151this option overrides it.  @xref{BFD}.
2152@end ifclear
2153
2154@kindex --out-implib
2155@item --out-implib @var{file}
2156Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2157the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program).  This import
2158library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2159may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2160behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2161step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs).  This option is only available for
2162the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2163
2164@kindex -pie
2165@kindex --pic-executable
2166@item -pie
2167@itemx --pic-executable
2168@cindex position independent executables
2169Create a position independent executable.  This is currently only supported on
2170ELF platforms.  Position independent executables are similar to shared
2171libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2172address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations).  Like
2173normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2174defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2175
2176@kindex -no-pie
2177@item -no-pie
2178@cindex position dependent executables
2179Create a position dependent executable.  This is the default.
2180
2181@kindex -qmagic
2182@item -qmagic
2183This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2184
2185@kindex -Qy
2186@item -Qy
2187This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2188
2189@kindex --relax
2190@cindex synthesizing linker
2191@cindex relaxing addressing modes
2192@cindex --no-relax
2193@item --relax
2194@itemx --no-relax
2195An option with machine dependent effects.
2196@ifset GENERIC
2197This option is only supported on a few targets.
2198@end ifset
2199@ifset H8300
2200@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2201@end ifset
2202@ifset XTENSA
2203@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2204@end ifset
2205@ifset M68HC11
2206@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2207@end ifset
2208@ifset NIOSII
2209@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2210@end ifset
2211@ifset POWERPC
2212@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2213@end ifset
2214
2215On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2216global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2217addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2218synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2219instructions, and combining constant values.
2220
2221On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2222debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2223@ifset GENERIC
2224This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2225family of processors.
2226@end ifset
2227
2228On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2229@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2230
2231On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2232and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2233
2234@cindex retaining specified symbols
2235@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2236@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2237@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2238@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2239Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2240discarding all others.  @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2241symbol name per line.  This option is especially useful in environments
2242@ifset GENERIC
2243(such as VxWorks)
2244@end ifset
2245where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2246run-time memory.
2247
2248@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2249or symbols needed for relocations.
2250
2251You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2252line.  It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2253
2254@ifset GENERIC
2255@item -rpath=@var{dir}
2256@cindex runtime library search path
2257@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2258Add a directory to the runtime library search path.  This is used when
2259linking an ELF executable with shared objects.  All @option{-rpath}
2260arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2261them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2262
2263The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2264are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2265description of the @option{-rpath-link} option.  Searching @option{-rpath}
2266in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2267have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2268
2269If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2270contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2271is defined.
2272
2273The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS.  By default, on
2274SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2275@option{-L} options it is given.  If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2276runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2277options, ignoring the @option{-L} options.  This can be useful when using
2278gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2279file systems.
2280
2281For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2282followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2283the @option{-rpath} option.
2284@end ifset
2285
2286@ifset GENERIC
2287@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2288@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2289@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2290When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another.  This
2291happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2292of the input files.
2293
2294When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2295non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2296shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2297explicitly.  In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2298specifies the first set of directories to search.  The
2299@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2300either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2301appearing multiple times.
2302
2303The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2304directories.  They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2305containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2306and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
230764-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2308
2309The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2310@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used.  The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2311supported.
2312
2313This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2314that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2315is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2316runtime linker would do.
2317
2318The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2319libraries:
2320
2321@enumerate
2322@item
2323Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2324@item
2325Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options.  The difference
2326between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2327specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2328used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2329at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2330by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2331the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2332@item
2333On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2334@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2335environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2336@item
2337On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2338directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2339@item
2340For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2341variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2342@item
2343For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2344@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2345libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2346@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2347@item
2348For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2349exists, the list of directories found in that file.  Note: the path
2350to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2351defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2352configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2353@item
2354For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2355the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2356header file.
2357@item
2358Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2359linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2360by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2361@item
2362The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2363@item
2364Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2365@item
2366Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2367linker script.
2368@end enumerate
2369
2370Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat:  If
2371the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2372is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2373library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2374@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2375directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2376this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2377@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2378of the first.
2379
2380If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2381warning and continue with the link.
2382
2383@end ifset
2384
2385@kindex -shared
2386@kindex -Bshareable
2387@item -shared
2388@itemx -Bshareable
2389@cindex shared libraries
2390Create a shared library.  This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2391and SunOS platforms.  On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2392shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2393undefined symbols in the link.
2394
2395@kindex --sort-common
2396@item --sort-common
2397@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2398@itemx --sort-common=descending
2399This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2400ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2401sections.  The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2402eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2403between symbols due to alignment constraints.  If no sorting order is
2404specified, then descending order is assumed.
2405
2406@kindex --sort-section=name
2407@item --sort-section=name
2408This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2409patterns in the linker script.
2410
2411@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2412@item --sort-section=alignment
2413This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2414patterns in the linker script.
2415
2416@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2417@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2418This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2419.dynamic section of ELF shared objects.  Empty slots may be needed by
2420post processing tools, such as the prelinker.  The default is 5.
2421
2422@kindex --split-by-file
2423@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2424Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2425each input file when @var{size} is reached.  @var{size} defaults to a
2426size of 1 if not given.
2427
2428@kindex --split-by-reloc
2429@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2430Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2431output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2432This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2433certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2434cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section.  Note
2435that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2436support arbitrary sections.  The linker will not split up individual
2437input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2438more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2439many relocations.  @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2440
2441@kindex --stats
2442@item --stats
2443Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2444as execution time and memory usage.
2445
2446@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2447@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2448Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2449configure-time default.  This option is only supported by linkers
2450that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2451
2452@kindex --task-link
2453@item --task-link
2454This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2455file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2456
2457@kindex --traditional-format
2458@cindex traditional format
2459@item --traditional-format
2460For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2461the output of some existing linker.  This switch requests @command{ld} to
2462use the traditional format instead.
2463
2464@cindex dbx
2465For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2466symbol string table.  This can reduce the size of an output file with
2467full debugging information by over 30 percent.  Unfortunately, the SunOS
2468@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2469trouble).  The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2470combine duplicate entries.
2471
2472@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2473@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2474Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2475address given by @var{org}.  You may use this option as many
2476times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2477line.
2478@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2479for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2480@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values.  @emph{Note:} there
2481should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2482sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2483
2484@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2485@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2486@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2487@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2488@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2489@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2490@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2491Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2492@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2493
2494@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2495@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2496@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2497When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2498byte of the text segment.
2499
2500@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2501@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2502@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2503When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2504the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2505text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2506
2507@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2508@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2509@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2510When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2511model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2512
2513@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2514@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2515Determine how to handle unresolved symbols.  There are four possible
2516values for @samp{method}:
2517
2518@table @samp
2519@item ignore-all
2520Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2521
2522@item report-all
2523Report all unresolved symbols.  This is the default.
2524
2525@item ignore-in-object-files
2526Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2527ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2528
2529@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2530Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2531ignore them if they come from shared libraries.  This can be useful
2532when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2533libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2534command line.
2535@end table
2536
2537The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2538by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2539
2540Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2541unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2542can change this to a warning.
2543
2544@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2545@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2546@item --dll-verbose
2547@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2548Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2549supported.  Display which input files can and cannot be opened.  Display
2550the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2551argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2552
2553@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2554@cindex version script, symbol versions
2555@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2556Specify the name of a version script to the linker.  This is typically
2557used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2558about the version hierarchy for the library being created.  This option
2559is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2560see @ref{VERSION}.  It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2561use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2562symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2563@xref{WIN32}.
2564
2565@kindex --warn-common
2566@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2567@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2568@item --warn-common
2569Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2570a symbol definition.  Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2571but linkers on some other operating systems do not.  This option allows
2572you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2573Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2574warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2575
2576There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2577
2578@table @samp
2579@item int i = 1;
2580A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2581file.
2582
2583@item extern int i;
2584An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2585There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2586variable somewhere.
2587
2588@item int i;
2589A common symbol.  If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2590variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2591The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2592single symbol.  If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2593size.  The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2594a definition of the same variable.
2595@end table
2596
2597The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2598Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2599just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2600encountered with the same name.  One or both of the two symbols will be
2601a common symbol.
2602
2603@enumerate
2604@item
2605Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2606definition for the symbol.
2607@smallexample
2608@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2609   overridden by definition
2610@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2611@end smallexample
2612
2613@item
2614Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2615the symbol is encountered.  This is the same as the previous case,
2616except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2617@smallexample
2618@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2619   overriding common
2620@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2621@end smallexample
2622
2623@item
2624Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2625@smallexample
2626@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2627   of `@var{symbol}'
2628@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2629@end smallexample
2630
2631@item
2632Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2633@smallexample
2634@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2635   overridden by larger common
2636@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2637@end smallexample
2638
2639@item
2640Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol.  This is
2641the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2642encountered in a different order.
2643@smallexample
2644@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2645   overriding smaller common
2646@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2647@end smallexample
2648@end enumerate
2649
2650@kindex --warn-constructors
2651@item --warn-constructors
2652Warn if any global constructors are used.  This is only useful for a few
2653object file formats.  For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2654detect the use of global constructors.
2655
2656@kindex --warn-execstack
2657@cindex warnings, on executable stack
2658@cindex executable stack, warnings on
2659@item --warn-execstack
2660@itemx --no-warn-execstack
2661On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2662messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack.  By
2663default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2664line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2665@option{--warn-execstack} option.
2666
2667On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2668executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2669stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
2670noexecstack} command line options have been specified.  This warning
2671can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2672
2673Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2674stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2675bit set in its section flags.  They can specify that they do not need
2676an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2677flag bit set.  If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2678section present then the default behaviour is target specific.  For
2679some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2680executable stack @emph{is} required.  This is often a problem for hand
2681crafted assembler files.
2682
2683@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2684@item --warn-multiple-gp
2685Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2686This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2687Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2688section.  A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2689of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2690base-register relative addressing mode.  Since the offset in
2691base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2692bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool.  Thus, in
2693large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2694values in order to be able to address all possible constants.  This
2695option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2696
2697@kindex --warn-once
2698@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2699@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2700@item --warn-once
2701Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2702which refers to it.
2703
2704@kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2705@cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2706@cindex executable segments, warnings on
2707@item --warn-rwx-segments
2708@itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2709Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2710all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set.  Such a
2711segment represents a potential security vulnerability.  In addition
2712warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2713created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2714not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2715
2716These warnings are enabled by default.  They can be disabled via the
2717@option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2718@option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2719
2720@kindex --warn-section-align
2721@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2722@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2723@item --warn-section-align
2724Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2725alignment.  Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2726The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2727is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2728the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2729
2730@kindex --warn-textrel
2731@item --warn-textrel
2732Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2733or shared object.
2734
2735@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2736@item --warn-alternate-em
2737Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2738
2739@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2740@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2741If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2742@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2743This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2744
2745@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2746@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2747This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2748it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2749
2750@kindex --whole-archive
2751@cindex including an entire archive
2752@item --whole-archive
2753For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2754@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2755in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2756files.  This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2757library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2758library.  This option may be used more than once.
2759
2760Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2761about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2762Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2763list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2764your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2765
2766@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2767@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2768Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}.  Any undefined reference to
2769@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}.  Any
2770undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2771@var{symbol}.
2772
2773This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function.  The
2774wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}.  If it
2775wishes to call the system function, it should call
2776@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2777
2778Here is a trivial example:
2779
2780@smallexample
2781void *
2782__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2783@{
2784  printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2785  return __real_malloc (c);
2786@}
2787@end smallexample
2788
2789If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2790all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2791instead.  The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2792call the real @code{malloc} function.
2793
2794You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2795links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed.  If you do this,
2796you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2797file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2798call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2799
2800Only undefined references are replaced by the linker.  So, translation unit
2801internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2802@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}.  In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2803@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2804
2805@smallexample
2806int
2807f (void)
2808@{
2809  return 123;
2810@}
2811
2812int
2813g (void)
2814@{
2815  return f();
2816@}
2817@end smallexample
2818
2819@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2820@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2821@item --eh-frame-hdr
2822@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2823Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2824(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2825section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2826
2827@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2828@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2829Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2830generated code sections like PLT.  This option is on by default
2831if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2832
2833@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2834@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2835@item --enable-new-dtags
2836@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2837This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2838systems may not understand them. If you specify
2839@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2840and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2841If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2842created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2843those options are only available for ELF systems.
2844
2845@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2846@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2847Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2848close to @var{number}.  Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2849time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2850increasing the linker's memory requirements.  Similarly reducing this
2851value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2852
2853@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2854@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2855Set the type of linker's hash table(s).  @var{style} can be either
2856@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2857new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2858the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2859hash tables.  The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2860but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2861
2862@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2863@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2864@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2865@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2866@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2867@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2868@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2869@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2870On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2871compressed using zlib.
2872
2873@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2874sections.  @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2875DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2876instead of @samp{.debug}.  @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2877also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2878sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2879
2880The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2881@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2882
2883Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2884sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2885for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2886uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2887
2888The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2889involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain.  The
2890default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2891@option{--help} option.
2892
2893@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2894@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2895This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2896linking speed.  This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2897for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2898about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2899
2900Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
29011021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2902run time.  This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2903has been used.
2904
2905The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2906enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2907
2908@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2909@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2910@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2911of input files in memory with the unlimited size.  This option sets the
2912maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2913
2914@kindex --build-id
2915@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2916@item --build-id
2917@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2918Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2919or a @code{.buildid} COFF section.  The contents of the note are
2920unique bits identifying this linked file.  @var{style} can be
2921@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2922@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2923@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2924the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2925string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2926@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored).  If @var{style}
2927is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2928
2929The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2930that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2931unique among all nonidentical output files.  It is not intended
2932to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents.  A linked
2933file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2934string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2935
2936Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2937@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2938
2939@kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2940@item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2941Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section.  The
2942contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
2943specification.  For more information see:
2944https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
2945If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
2946creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
2947occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
2948If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
2949will be validated.
2950@end table
2951
2952@c man end
2953
2954@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2955
2956@c man begin OPTIONS
2957
2958The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2959the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2960normal executable.  You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2961use this option.  In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2962@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2963like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2964symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2965object file).
2966
2967In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2968support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2969PE target.  Options that take values may be separated from their
2970values by either a space or an equals sign.
2971
2972@table @gcctabopt
2973
2974@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2975@item --add-stdcall-alias
2976If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2977as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2978[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2979
2980@kindex --base-file
2981@item --base-file @var{file}
2982Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2983addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2984@file{dlltool}.
2985[This is an i386 PE specific option]
2986
2987@kindex --dll
2988@item --dll
2989Create a DLL instead of a regular executable.  You may also use
2990@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2991file.
2992[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2993
2994@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2995@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2996@item --enable-long-section-names
2997@itemx --disable-long-section-names
2998The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2999the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
3000for COFF.  By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3001fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
3002to support the longer names.  As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3003allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3004disallow it in object files, by using these two options.  Executable images
3005generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3006as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
3007with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers.  However,
3008GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3009information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3010option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3011section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3012when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3013image and not stripping symbols.
3014[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3015
3016@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3017@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3018@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3019@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3020If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
3021do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
3022only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3023resolve that symbol by linking to the match.  For example, the
3024undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3025@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3026to the function @code{_bar}.  When the linker does this, it prints a
3027warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3028import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
3029to be usable.  If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
3030feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed.  If you specify
3031@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
3032mismatches are considered to be errors.
3033[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3034
3035@kindex --leading-underscore
3036@kindex --no-leading-underscore
3037@item --leading-underscore
3038@itemx --no-leading-underscore
3039For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3040in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3041disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3042
3043@cindex DLLs, creating
3044@kindex --export-all-symbols
3045@item --export-all-symbols
3046If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3047be exported by the DLL.  Note that this is the default if there
3048otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols.  When symbols are
3049explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3050attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3051option is given.  Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
3052@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
3053@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
3054exported.  Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3055re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3056such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3057@code{_iname}.  In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
3058@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3059Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3060not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs.  Finally, there is an
3061extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
3062(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
3063These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3064@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3065@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3066@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3067@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3068[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3069
3070@kindex --exclude-symbols
3071@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3072Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3073exported.  The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3074[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3075
3076@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3077@item --exclude-all-symbols
3078Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3079[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3080
3081@kindex --file-alignment
3082@item --file-alignment
3083Specify the file alignment.  Sections in the file will always begin at
3084file offsets which are multiples of this number.  This defaults to
3085512.
3086[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3087
3088@cindex heap size
3089@kindex --heap
3090@item --heap @var{reserve}
3091@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3092Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3093to be used as heap for this program.  The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3094committed.
3095[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3096
3097@cindex image base
3098@kindex --image-base
3099@item --image-base @var{value}
3100Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll.  This is
3101the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3102is loaded.  To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3103your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3104other dlls.  The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3105for dlls.
3106[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3107
3108@kindex --kill-at
3109@item --kill-at
3110If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3111symbols before they are exported.
3112[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3113
3114@kindex --large-address-aware
3115@item --large-address-aware
3116If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3117header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3118greater than 2 gigabytes.  This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3119or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3120section of the BOOT.INI.  Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3121[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3122
3123@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3124@item --disable-large-address-aware
3125Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3126This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3127driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3128addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3129[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3130
3131@kindex --major-image-version
3132@item --major-image-version @var{value}
3133Sets the major number of the ``image version''.  Defaults to 1.
3134[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3135
3136@kindex --major-os-version
3137@item --major-os-version @var{value}
3138Sets the major number of the ``os version''.  Defaults to 4.
3139[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3140
3141@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3142@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3143Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''.  Defaults to 4.
3144[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3145
3146@kindex --minor-image-version
3147@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3148Sets the minor number of the ``image version''.  Defaults to 0.
3149[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3150
3151@kindex --minor-os-version
3152@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3153Sets the minor number of the ``os version''.  Defaults to 0.
3154[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3155
3156@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3157@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3158Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''.  Defaults to 0.
3159[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3160
3161@cindex DEF files, creating
3162@cindex DLLs, creating
3163@kindex --output-def
3164@item --output-def @var{file}
3165The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3166file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating.  This DEF file
3167(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3168library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3169automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3170[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3171
3172@cindex DLLs, creating
3173@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3174@item --enable-auto-image-base
3175@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3176Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3177@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3178By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3179for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3180execution are avoided.
3181[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3182
3183@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3184@item --disable-auto-image-base
3185Do not automatically generate a unique image base.  If there is no
3186user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3187default.
3188[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3189
3190@cindex DLLs, linking to
3191@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3192@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3193When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3194search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3195@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3196between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3197uwin, pw, etc.  For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3198@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3199[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3200
3201@kindex --enable-auto-import
3202@item --enable-auto-import
3203Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3204DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3205mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3206[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3207
3208The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3209feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3210
3211Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3212of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3213PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3214
3215Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3216data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3217placed into the .data section instead.  This is in order to work
3218around a problem with consts that is described here:
3219http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3220
3221Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3222see this message:
3223
3224"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3225documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3226
3227This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3228ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3229allow one).  Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3230fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3231constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL.  Any
3232multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3233this error condition.  However, regardless of the exact data type
3234of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3235the warning, and exit.
3236
3237There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3238data type of the exported variable:
3239
3240One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3241of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3242this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3243
3244A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3245that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time.  For arrays,
3246there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3247a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable.  Thus:
3248
3249@example
3250extern type extern_array[];
3251extern_array[1] -->
3252   @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3253@end example
3254
3255or
3256
3257@example
3258extern type extern_array[];
3259extern_array[1] -->
3260   @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3261@end example
3262
3263For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3264is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3265
3266@example
3267extern struct s extern_struct;
3268extern_struct.field -->
3269   @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3270@end example
3271
3272or
3273
3274@example
3275extern long long extern_ll;
3276extern_ll -->
3277  @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3278@end example
3279
3280A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3281'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3282@code{__declspec(dllimport)}.  However, in practice that
3283requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3284building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3285merely building/linking to a static library.   In making the choice
3286between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3287constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3288
3289Original:
3290@example
3291--foo.h
3292extern int arr[];
3293--foo.c
3294#include "foo.h"
3295void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3296  printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3297@}
3298@end example
3299
3300Solution 1:
3301@example
3302--foo.h
3303extern int arr[];
3304--foo.c
3305#include "foo.h"
3306void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3307  /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3308  volatile int *parr = arr;
3309  printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3310@}
3311@end example
3312
3313Solution 2:
3314@example
3315--foo.h
3316/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3317#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3318  !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3319#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3320#else
3321#define FOO_IMPORT
3322#endif
3323extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3324--foo.c
3325#include "foo.h"
3326void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3327  printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3328@}
3329@end example
3330
3331A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3332library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3333for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3334functions).
3335
3336@kindex --disable-auto-import
3337@item --disable-auto-import
3338Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3339@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3340[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3341
3342@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3343@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3344If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3345that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3346a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3347environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3348[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3349
3350@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3351@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3352Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3353[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3354
3355@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3356@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3357Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3358[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3359
3360@kindex --section-alignment
3361@item --section-alignment
3362Sets the section alignment.  Sections in memory will always begin at
3363addresses which are a multiple of this number.  Defaults to 0x1000.
3364[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3365
3366@cindex stack size
3367@kindex --stack
3368@item --stack @var{reserve}
3369@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3370Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3371to be used as stack for this program.  The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3372committed.
3373[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3374
3375@kindex --subsystem
3376@item --subsystem @var{which}
3377@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3378@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3379Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute.  The
3380legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3381@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}.  You may optionally set
3382the subsystem version also.  Numeric values are also accepted for
3383@var{which}.
3384[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3385
3386The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3387of the PE file header:
3388[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3389
3390@kindex --high-entropy-va
3391@item --high-entropy-va
3392@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3393Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3394(ASLR).  This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3395
3396This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3397@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3398
3399@kindex --dynamicbase
3400@item --dynamicbase
3401@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3402The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3403randomization (ASLR).  This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3404Vista for i386 PE targets.  This option is enabled by default but
3405can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3406This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3407
3408@kindex --forceinteg
3409@item --forceinteg
3410@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3411Code integrity checks are enforced.  This option is disabled by
3412default.
3413
3414@kindex --nxcompat
3415@item --nxcompat
3416@item --disable-nxcompat
3417The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3418This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3419targets.  The option is enabled by default.
3420
3421@kindex --no-isolation
3422@item --no-isolation
3423@itemx --disable-no-isolation
3424Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3425This option is disabled by default.
3426
3427@kindex --no-seh
3428@item --no-seh
3429@itemx --disable-no-seh
3430The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3431this image.  This option is disabled by default.
3432
3433@kindex --no-bind
3434@item --no-bind
3435@itemx --disable-no-bind
3436Do not bind this image.  This option is disabled by default.
3437
3438@kindex --wdmdriver
3439@item --wdmdriver
3440@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3441The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model.  This option is disabled
3442by default.
3443
3444@kindex --tsaware
3445@item --tsaware
3446@itemx --disable-tsaware
3447The image is Terminal Server aware.  This option is disabled by
3448default.
3449
3450@kindex --insert-timestamp
3451@item --insert-timestamp
3452@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3453Insert a real timestamp into the image.  This is the default behaviour
3454as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3455other, proprietary tools.  The problem with this default is that it
3456will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3457same sources are linked.  The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3458can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3459that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3460identically.
3461
3462@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3463@item --enable-reloc-section
3464@itemx --disable-reloc-section
3465Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3466is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3467This option is enabled by default.
3468@end table
3469
3470@c man end
3471
3472@ifset C6X
3473@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3474
3475@c man begin OPTIONS
3476
3477The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3478libraries.  Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3479all executables use an index of 0.
3480
3481@table @gcctabopt
3482
3483@kindex --dsbt-size
3484@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3485This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3486or shared library to @var{size}.  The default is to create a table with 64
3487entries.
3488
3489@kindex --dsbt-index
3490@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3491This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3492to @var{index}.  The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3493executables.  If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3494@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3495
3496@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3497The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3498exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3499
3500@end table
3501
3502@c man end
3503@end ifset
3504
3505@ifset CSKY
3506@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3507
3508@c man begin OPTIONS
3509
3510@table @gcctabopt
3511
3512@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3513@item --branch-stub
3514This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3515sections when needed to extend the range of branches.  This option is
3516usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3517can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3518the compiler or assembler.
3519
3520@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3521@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3522This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3523It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3524be handled by one stub section.  A negative value of @var{N} locates
3525stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3526sections to appear either before or after the branches.  Values of
3527@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3528linker should choose suitable defaults.
3529
3530@end table
3531
3532@c man end
3533@end ifset
3534
3535@ifset M68HC11
3536@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3537
3538@c man begin OPTIONS
3539
3540The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3541memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3542
3543@table @gcctabopt
3544
3545@kindex --no-trampoline
3546@item --no-trampoline
3547This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3548is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3549instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3550
3551@kindex --bank-window
3552@item --bank-window @var{name}
3553This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3554the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3555The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3556paging and addresses within the memory window.
3557
3558@end table
3559
3560@c man end
3561@end ifset
3562
3563@ifset M68K
3564@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3565
3566@c man begin OPTIONS
3567
3568The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3569when linking for 68K targets.
3570
3571@table @gcctabopt
3572
3573@kindex --got
3574@item --got=@var{type}
3575This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3576@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3577@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}.  For more information refer to the
3578Info entry for @file{ld}.
3579
3580@end table
3581
3582@c man end
3583@end ifset
3584
3585@ifset MIPS
3586@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3587
3588@c man begin OPTIONS
3589
3590The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3591generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3592linking for MIPS targets.
3593
3594@table @gcctabopt
3595
3596@kindex --insn32
3597@item --insn32
3598@kindex --no-insn32
3599@itemx --no-insn32
3600These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3601generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3602or in relaxation.  If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
360332-bit instruction encodings.  By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3604used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3605possible.
3606
3607@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3608@item --ignore-branch-isa
3609@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3610@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3611These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3612transitions.  If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3613accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3614is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3615instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3616equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3617calculated.  By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3618a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3619an error.
3620
3621@kindex --compact-branches
3622@item --compact-branches
3623@kindex --no-compact-branches
3624@itemx --no-compact-branches
3625These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3626in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3627
3628@end table
3629
3630@c man end
3631@end ifset
3632
3633
3634@ifset PDP11
3635@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3636
3637@c man begin OPTIONS
3638
3639For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3640produced as selected by the following options.  The default variant
3641for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3642targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default.  The @samp{--imagic} option is
3643defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3644here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3645
3646@table @gcctabopt
3647
3648@kindex -N
3649@item -N
3650@kindex --omagic
3651@itemx --omagic
3652
3653Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3654indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3655shared.  Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3656writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3657the text segment.  This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3658programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3659from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3660
3661@kindex -n
3662@item -n
3663@kindex --nmagic
3664@itemx --nmagic
3665
3666Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3667indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3668be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3669file.  This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3670byte page boundary following the end of the text.  This option creates
3671a @emph{pure executable} format.
3672
3673@kindex -z
3674@item -z
3675@kindex --imagic
3676@itemx --imagic
3677
3678Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3679indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3680data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3681instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3682larger models of the PDP11.  This doubles the address space available
3683to the program.  The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3684shareable.  The only difference in the output format between this
3685option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3686and data sections start at location 0.  The @samp{-z} option selected
3687this format in 2.11BSD.  This option creates a @emph{separate
3688executable} format.
3689
3690@kindex --no-omagic
3691@item --no-omagic
3692
3693Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3694
3695@end table
3696
3697@c man end
3698@end ifset
3699
3700@ifset UsesEnvVars
3701@node Environment
3702@section Environment Variables
3703
3704@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3705
3706You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3707@ifclear SingleFormat
3708@code{GNUTARGET},
3709@end ifclear
3710@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3711
3712@ifclear SingleFormat
3713@kindex GNUTARGET
3714@cindex default input format
3715@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3716use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}).  Its value should be one
3717of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}).  If there is no
3718@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3719of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3720attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3721this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3722there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3723object-file formats is unique.  However, the configuration procedure for
3724BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3725in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3726@end ifclear
3727
3728@kindex LDEMULATION
3729@cindex default emulation
3730@cindex emulation, default
3731@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3732@samp{-m} option.  The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3733behaviour, particularly the default linker script.  You can list the
3734available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.  If
3735the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3736variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3737linker was configured.
3738
3739@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3740@cindex demangling, default
3741Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols.  However, if
3742@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3743default to not demangling symbols.  This environment variable is used in
3744a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program.  The default
3745may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3746options.
3747
3748@c man end
3749@end ifset
3750
3751@node Scripts
3752@chapter Linker Scripts
3753
3754@cindex scripts
3755@cindex linker scripts
3756@cindex command files
3757Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}.  This script is
3758written in the linker command language.
3759
3760The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3761the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3762the memory layout of the output file.  Most linker scripts do nothing
3763more than this.  However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3764direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3765described below.
3766
3767The linker always uses a linker script.  If you do not supply one
3768yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3769linker executable.  You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3770to display the default linker script.  Certain command-line options,
3771such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3772
3773You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3774line option.  When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3775default linker script.
3776
3777You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3778to the linker, as though they were files to be linked.  @xref{Implicit
3779Linker Scripts}.
3780
3781@menu
3782* Basic Script Concepts::	Basic Linker Script Concepts
3783* Script Format::		Linker Script Format
3784* Simple Example::		Simple Linker Script Example
3785* Simple Commands::		Simple Linker Script Commands
3786* Assignments::			Assigning Values to Symbols
3787* SECTIONS::			SECTIONS Command
3788* MEMORY::			MEMORY Command
3789* PHDRS::			PHDRS Command
3790* VERSION::			VERSION Command
3791* Expressions::			Expressions in Linker Scripts
3792* Implicit Linker Scripts::	Implicit Linker Scripts
3793@end menu
3794
3795@node Basic Script Concepts
3796@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3797@cindex linker script concepts
3798We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3799describe the linker script language.
3800
3801The linker combines input files into a single output file.  The output
3802file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3803@dfn{object file format}.  Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3804The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3805purposes we will also call it an object file.  Each object file has,
3806among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}.  We sometimes refer to a
3807section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3808in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3809
3810Each section in an object file has a name and a size.  Most sections
3811also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3812contents}.  A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3813the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3814A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3815area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3816loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out).  A section
3817which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3818of debugging information.
3819
3820Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses.  The
3821first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address.  This is the address
3822the section will have when the output file is run.  The second is the
3823@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address.  This is the address at which the
3824section will be loaded.  In most cases the two addresses will be the
3825same.  An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3826is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3827(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3828based system).  In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3829RAM address would be the VMA.
3830
3831You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3832program with the @samp{-h} option.
3833
3834Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3835@dfn{symbol table}.  A symbol may be defined or undefined.  Each symbol
3836has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3837information.  If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3838will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3839static variable.  Every undefined function or global variable which is
3840referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3841
3842You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3843program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3844option.
3845
3846@node Script Format
3847@section Linker Script Format
3848@cindex linker script format
3849Linker scripts are text files.
3850
3851You write a linker script as a series of commands.  Each command is
3852either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3853symbol.  You may separate commands using semicolons.  Whitespace is
3854generally ignored.
3855
3856Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3857If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3858otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3859double quotes.  There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3860file name.
3861
3862You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3863@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}.  As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3864to whitespace.
3865
3866@node Simple Example
3867@section Simple Linker Script Example
3868@cindex linker script example
3869@cindex example of linker script
3870Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3871
3872The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3873@samp{SECTIONS}.  You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3874memory layout of the output file.
3875
3876The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command.  Here we will
3877describe a simple use of it.  Let's assume your program consists only of
3878code, initialized data, and uninitialized data.  These will be in the
3879@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3880Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3881your input files.
3882
3883For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
38840x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000.  Here is a
3885linker script which will do that:
3886@smallexample
3887SECTIONS
3888@{
3889  . = 0x10000;
3890  .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3891  . = 0x8000000;
3892  .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3893  .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3894@}
3895@end smallexample
3896
3897You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3898followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3899descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3900
3901The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3902sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3903counter.  If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3904other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3905current value of the location counter.  The location counter is then
3906incremented by the size of the output section.  At the start of the
3907@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3908
3909The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}.  The colon is
3910required syntax which may be ignored for now.  Within the curly braces
3911after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3912which should be placed into this output section.  The @samp{*} is a
3913wildcard which matches any file name.  The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3914means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3915
3916Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3917@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3918@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3919
3920The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3921the output file.  The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3922at address @samp{0x8000000}.  After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3923output section, the value of the location counter will be
3924@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section.  The
3925effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3926immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3927
3928The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3929alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary.  In this
3930example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3931sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3932may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3933sections.
3934
3935That's it!  That's a simple and complete linker script.
3936
3937@node Simple Commands
3938@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3939@cindex linker script simple commands
3940In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3941
3942@menu
3943* Entry Point::			Setting the entry point
3944* File Commands::		Commands dealing with files
3945@ifclear SingleFormat
3946* Format Commands::		Commands dealing with object file formats
3947@end ifclear
3948
3949* REGION_ALIAS::		Assign alias names to memory regions
3950* Miscellaneous Commands::	Other linker script commands
3951@end menu
3952
3953@node Entry Point
3954@subsection Setting the Entry Point
3955@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3956@cindex start of execution
3957@cindex first instruction
3958@cindex entry point
3959The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3960point}.  You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3961entry point.  The argument is a symbol name:
3962@smallexample
3963ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3964@end smallexample
3965
3966There are several ways to set the entry point.  The linker will set the
3967entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3968stopping when one of them succeeds:
3969@itemize @bullet
3970@item
3971the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3972@item
3973the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3974@item
3975the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined;  For many
3976targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3977check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3978@item
3979the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3980executable is being created - the code section is usually
3981@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
3982@item
3983The address @code{0}.
3984@end itemize
3985
3986@node File Commands
3987@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3988@cindex linker script file commands
3989Several linker script commands deal with files.
3990
3991@table @code
3992@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3993@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3994@cindex including a linker script
3995Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point.  The file will
3996be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3997with the @option{-L} option.  You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
399810 levels deep.
3999
4000You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4001@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4002
4003@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4004@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4005@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4006@cindex input files in linker scripts
4007@cindex input object files in linker scripts
4008@cindex linker script input object files
4009The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4010in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4011
4012For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4013a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4014then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4015
4016In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4017script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4018
4019In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4020with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4021located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
4022for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}.  The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4023@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4024filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4025@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4026
4027If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4028the file in the directory containing the linker script.  If it is not
4029found the linker will then search the current directory.  If it is still
4030not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4031path.
4032
4033If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
4034name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
4035@samp{-l}.
4036
4037When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4038files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4039script file is included.  This can affect archive searching.
4040
4041@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4042@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4043@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4044@cindex grouping input files
4045The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4046files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4047new undefined references are created.  See the description of @samp{-(}
4048in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4049
4050@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4051@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4052@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4053This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4054commands, among other filenames.  The files listed will be handled
4055as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4056with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4057when they are actually needed.  This construct essentially enables
4058@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4059and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4060setting afterwards.
4061
4062@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4063@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4064@cindex output file name in linker script
4065The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file.  Using
4066@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4067@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4068Line Options}).  If both are used, the command-line option takes
4069precedence.
4070
4071You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4072output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4073
4074@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4075@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4076@cindex library search path in linker script
4077@cindex archive search path in linker script
4078@cindex search path in linker script
4079The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4080@command{ld} looks for archive libraries.  Using
4081@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4082on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}).  If both
4083are used, then the linker will search both paths.  Paths specified using
4084the command-line option are searched first.
4085
4086@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4087@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4088@cindex first input file
4089The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4090that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4091though it were specified first on the command line.  This may be useful
4092when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4093first file.
4094@end table
4095
4096@ifclear SingleFormat
4097@node Format Commands
4098@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4099A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4100
4101@table @code
4102@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4103@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4104@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4105@cindex output file format in linker script
4106The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4107output file (@pxref{BFD}).  Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4108exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4109(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}).  If both are used, the command
4110line option takes precedence.
4111
4112You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4113formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4114This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4115desired endianness.
4116
4117If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4118will be the first argument, @var{default}.  If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4119output format will be the second argument, @var{big}.  If @samp{-EL} is
4120used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4121
4122For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4123command:
4124@smallexample
4125OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4126@end smallexample
4127This says that the default format for the output file is
4128@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4129option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4130format.
4131
4132@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4133@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4134@cindex input file format in linker script
4135The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4136files.  It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4137This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4138(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}).  If the @code{TARGET} command
4139is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4140command is also used to set the format for the output file.  @xref{BFD}.
4141@end table
4142@end ifclear
4143
4144@node REGION_ALIAS
4145@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4146@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4147@cindex region alias
4148@cindex region names
4149
4150Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4151@ref{MEMORY} command.  Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4152
4153@smallexample
4154REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4155@end smallexample
4156
4157The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4158memory region @var{region}.  This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4159to memory regions.  An example follows.
4160
4161Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4162memory storage devices.  All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4163that allows code execution or data storage.  Some may have a read-only,
4164non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4165access.  The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4166read-only data access and no code execution capability.  We have four output
4167sections:
4168
4169@itemize @bullet
4170@item
4171@code{.text} program code;
4172@item
4173@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4174@item
4175@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4176@item
4177@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4178@end itemize
4179
4180The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4181part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4182output sections to the memory regions available on the system.  Our embedded
4183systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4184@code{C}:
4185@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4186@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4187@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4188@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4189@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4190@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4191@end multitable
4192The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4193loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively.  Please note that
4194the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4195the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4196
4197The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows.  It
4198includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4199memory layout:
4200@smallexample
4201INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4202
4203SECTIONS
4204  @{
4205    .text :
4206      @{
4207        *(.text)
4208      @} > REGION_TEXT
4209    .rodata :
4210      @{
4211        *(.rodata)
4212        rodata_end = .;
4213      @} > REGION_RODATA
4214    .data : AT (rodata_end)
4215      @{
4216        data_start = .;
4217        *(.data)
4218      @} > REGION_DATA
4219    data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4220    data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4221    .bss :
4222      @{
4223        *(.bss)
4224      @} > REGION_BSS
4225  @}
4226@end smallexample
4227
4228Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4229regions and alias names.  The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4230variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4231@table @code
4232@item A
4233Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4234@smallexample
4235MEMORY
4236  @{
4237    RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4238  @}
4239
4240REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4241REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4242REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4243REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4244@end smallexample
4245@item B
4246Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}.  Read-write data goes
4247into the @code{RAM}.  An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4248@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4249@smallexample
4250MEMORY
4251  @{
4252    ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4253    RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4254  @}
4255
4256REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4257REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4258REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4259REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4260@end smallexample
4261@item C
4262Program code goes into the @code{ROM}.  Read-only data goes into the
4263@code{ROM2}.  Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}.  An image of the
4264initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4265system start into the @code{RAM}.
4266@smallexample
4267MEMORY
4268  @{
4269    ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4270    ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4271    RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4272  @}
4273
4274REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4275REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4276REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4277REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4278@end smallexample
4279@end table
4280
4281It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4282@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4283necessary:
4284@smallexample
4285#include <string.h>
4286
4287extern char data_start [];
4288extern char data_size [];
4289extern char data_load_start [];
4290
4291void copy_data(void)
4292@{
4293  if (data_start != data_load_start)
4294    @{
4295      memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4296    @}
4297@}
4298@end smallexample
4299
4300@node Miscellaneous Commands
4301@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4302There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4303
4304@table @code
4305@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4306@kindex ASSERT
4307@cindex assertion in linker script
4308Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero.  If it is zero, then exit the linker
4309with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4310
4311Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4312take place.  This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4313inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4314for those symbols.  The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4315symbols that just reference dot.  Thus an assertion like this:
4316
4317@smallexample
4318  .stack :
4319  @{
4320    PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4321    PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4322    ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4323  @}
4324@end smallexample
4325
4326will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere.  Symbols
4327PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4328can be used inside ASSERTions.  Thus:
4329
4330@smallexample
4331  PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4332  .stack :
4333  @{
4334    PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4335    ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4336  @}
4337@end smallexample
4338
4339will work.
4340
4341@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4342@kindex EXTERN
4343@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4344Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4345symbol.  Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4346modules from standard libraries.  You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4347each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times.  This
4348command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4349
4350@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4351@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4352@cindex common allocation in linker script
4353This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4354to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4355output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4356
4357@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4358@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4359@cindex common allocation in linker script
4360This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4361command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4362to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4363
4364@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4365@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4366@cindex group allocation in linker script
4367@cindex section groups
4368@cindex COMDAT
4369This command has the same effect as the
4370@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4371@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4372and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4373specified (@samp{-r}).
4374
4375@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4376@kindex INSERT
4377@cindex insert user script into default script
4378This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4379augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays.  It
4380inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4381@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4382default linker script.  The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4383sections.  @xref{Location Counter}.  The insertion happens after the
4384linker has mapped input sections to output sections.  Prior to the
4385insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4386linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4387default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4388of the script.  In particular, input section assignments will be made
4389to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script.  Here
4390is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4391
4392@smallexample
4393SECTIONS
4394@{
4395  OVERLAY :
4396  @{
4397    .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4398    .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4399  @}
4400@}
4401INSERT AFTER .text;
4402@end smallexample
4403
4404@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4405@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4406@cindex cross references
4407This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4408references among certain output sections.
4409
4410In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4411using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4412will not be.  Any direct references between the two sections would be
4413errors.  For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4414a function defined in the other section.
4415
4416The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names.  If
4417@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4418an error and returns a non-zero exit status.  Note that the
4419@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4420names.
4421
4422@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4423@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4424@cindex cross references
4425This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4426references to one section from a list of other sections.
4427
4428The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4429output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4430a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4431there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4432must never call back.
4433
4434The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4435The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4436If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4437the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4438status.  Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4439names, not input section names.
4440
4441@ifclear SingleFormat
4442@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4443@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4444@cindex machine architecture
4445@cindex architecture
4446Specify a particular output machine architecture.  The argument is one
4447of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}).  You can see the
4448architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4449the @samp{-f} option.
4450@end ifclear
4451
4452@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4453@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4454This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior.  If
4455@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4456in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4457@xref{Expression Section}.
4458@end table
4459
4460@node Assignments
4461@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4462@cindex assignment in scripts
4463@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4464@cindex variables, defining
4465You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script.  This will define
4466the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4467
4468@menu
4469* Simple Assignments::		Simple Assignments
4470* HIDDEN::			HIDDEN
4471* PROVIDE::			PROVIDE
4472* PROVIDE_HIDDEN::		PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4473* Source Code Reference::	How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4474@end menu
4475
4476@node Simple Assignments
4477@subsection Simple Assignments
4478
4479You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4480
4481@table @code
4482@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4483@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4484@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4485@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4486@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4487@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4488@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4489@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4490@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4491@end table
4492
4493The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4494@var{expression}.  In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4495defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4496
4497The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter.  You
4498may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command.  @xref{Location Counter}.
4499
4500The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4501
4502Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4503
4504You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4505statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4506section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4507
4508The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4509expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4510
4511Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4512assignments may be used:
4513
4514@smallexample
4515floating_point = 0;
4516SECTIONS
4517@{
4518  .text :
4519    @{
4520      *(.text)
4521      _etext = .;
4522    @}
4523  _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4524  .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4525@}
4526@end smallexample
4527@noindent
4528In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4529zero.  The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4530the last @samp{.text} input section.  The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4531defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4532upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4533
4534@node HIDDEN
4535@subsection HIDDEN
4536@cindex HIDDEN
4537For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4538exported.  The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4539
4540Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4541@code{HIDDEN}:
4542
4543@smallexample
4544HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4545SECTIONS
4546@{
4547  .text :
4548    @{
4549      *(.text)
4550      HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4551    @}
4552  HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4553  .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4554@}
4555@end smallexample
4556@noindent
4557In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4558
4559@node PROVIDE
4560@subsection PROVIDE
4561@cindex PROVIDE
4562In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4563only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4564the link.  For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4565@samp{etext}.  However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4566@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error.  The
4567@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4568@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined.  The syntax is
4569@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4570
4571Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4572@smallexample
4573SECTIONS
4574@{
4575  .text :
4576    @{
4577      *(.text)
4578      _etext = .;
4579      PROVIDE(etext = .);
4580    @}
4581@}
4582@end smallexample
4583
4584In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4585underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic.  If,
4586on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4587underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4588If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4589linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4590
4591Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4592defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4593that the @code{PROVIDE} would create.  This is particularly important
4594when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4595@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4596
4597@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4598@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4599@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4600Similar to @code{PROVIDE}.  For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4601hidden and won't be exported.
4602
4603@node Source Code Reference
4604@subsection Source Code Reference
4605
4606Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4607intuitive.  In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4608a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4609symbol that does not have a value.
4610
4611Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4612transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4613stored in the symbol table.  For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4614prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4615mangling}.  Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4616of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4617variable as it is defined in a linker script.  For example in C a
4618linker script variable might be referred to as:
4619
4620@smallexample
4621  extern int foo;
4622@end smallexample
4623
4624But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4625
4626@smallexample
4627  _foo = 1000;
4628@end smallexample
4629
4630In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4631transformation has taken place.
4632
4633When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4634things happen.  The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4635in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol.  The
4636second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4637table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}.  ie the symbol table
4638contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4639value.  So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4640
4641@smallexample
4642  int foo = 1000;
4643@end smallexample
4644
4645creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table.  This entry
4646holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4647number 1000 is initially stored.
4648
4649When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4650first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4651memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4652So:
4653
4654@smallexample
4655  foo = 1;
4656@end smallexample
4657
4658looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4659associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4660address.  Whereas:
4661
4662@smallexample
4663  int * a = & foo;
4664@end smallexample
4665
4666looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4667and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4668the variable @samp{a}.
4669
4670Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4671the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them.  Thus they are
4672an address without a value.  So for example the linker script definition:
4673
4674@smallexample
4675  foo = 1000;
4676@end smallexample
4677
4678creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4679the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4680address 1000.  This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4681linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4682access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4683
4684Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4685you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4686use its value.  For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4687section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4688linker script contains these declarations:
4689
4690@smallexample
4691@group
4692  start_of_ROM   = .ROM;
4693  end_of_ROM     = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4694  start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4695@end group
4696@end smallexample
4697
4698Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4699
4700@smallexample
4701@group
4702  extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4703
4704  memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4705@end group
4706@end smallexample
4707
4708Note the use of the @samp{&} operators.  These are correct.
4709Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4710arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4711
4712@smallexample
4713@group
4714  extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4715
4716  memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4717@end group
4718@end smallexample
4719
4720Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4721operators.
4722
4723@node SECTIONS
4724@section SECTIONS Command
4725@kindex SECTIONS
4726The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4727into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4728
4729The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4730@smallexample
4731SECTIONS
4732@{
4733  @var{sections-command}
4734  @var{sections-command}
4735  @dots{}
4736@}
4737@end smallexample
4738
4739Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4740
4741@itemize @bullet
4742@item
4743an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4744@item
4745a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4746@item
4747an output section description
4748@item
4749an overlay description
4750@end itemize
4751
4752The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4753@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4754those commands.  This can also make the linker script easier to
4755understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4756the layout of the output file.
4757
4758Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4759below.
4760
4761If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4762linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4763section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4764input files.  If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4765example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4766in the first input file.  The first section will be at address zero.
4767
4768@menu
4769* Output Section Description::	Output section description
4770* Output Section Name::		Output section name
4771* Output Section Address::	Output section address
4772* Input Section::		Input section description
4773* Output Section Data::		Output section data
4774* Output Section Keywords::	Output section keywords
4775* Output Section Discarding::	Output section discarding
4776* Output Section Attributes::	Output section attributes
4777* Overlay Description::		Overlay description
4778@end menu
4779
4780@node Output Section Description
4781@subsection Output Section Description
4782The full description of an output section looks like this:
4783@smallexample
4784@group
4785@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4786  [AT(@var{lma})]
4787  [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4788  [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4789  [@var{constraint}]
4790  @{
4791    @var{output-section-command}
4792    @var{output-section-command}
4793    @dots{}
4794  @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4795@end group
4796@end smallexample
4797
4798Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4799
4800The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4801name is unambiguous.  The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4802The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4803the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4804The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4805
4806Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4807
4808@itemize @bullet
4809@item
4810a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4811@item
4812an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4813@item
4814data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4815@item
4816a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4817@end itemize
4818
4819@node Output Section Name
4820@subsection Output Section Name
4821@cindex name, section
4822@cindex section name
4823The name of the output section is @var{section}.  @var{section} must
4824meet the constraints of your output format.  In formats which only
4825support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4826must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4827example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4828output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4829names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4830quoted numeric string.  A section name may consist of any sequence of
4831characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4832commas must be quoted.
4833
4834The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4835Discarding}.
4836
4837@node Output Section Address
4838@subsection Output Section Address
4839@cindex address, section
4840@cindex section address
4841The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4842address) of the output section.  This address is optional, but if it
4843is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4844
4845If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4846section, based on the heuristic below.  This address will be adjusted
4847to fit the alignment requirement of the output section.  The
4848alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4849contained within the output section.
4850
4851The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4852
4853@itemize @bullet
4854@item
4855If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4856is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4857in that region.
4858
4859@item
4860If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4861regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4862section is selected to contain it.  The section's output address will
4863be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4864
4865@item
4866If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4867the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4868counter.
4869@end itemize
4870
4871@noindent
4872For example:
4873
4874@smallexample
4875.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4876@end smallexample
4877
4878@noindent
4879and
4880
4881@smallexample
4882.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4883@end smallexample
4884
4885@noindent
4886are subtly different.  The first will set the address of the
4887@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4888counter.  The second will set it to the current value of the location
4889counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4890input sections.
4891
4892The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4893For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4894so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4895do something like this:
4896@smallexample
4897.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4898@end smallexample
4899@noindent
4900This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4901aligned upward to the specified value.
4902
4903Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4904location counter, provided that the section is non-empty.  (Empty
4905sections are ignored).
4906
4907@node Input Section
4908@subsection Input Section Description
4909@cindex input sections
4910@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4911The most common output section command is an input section description.
4912
4913The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4914You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4915in memory.  You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4916map the input files into your memory layout.
4917
4918@menu
4919* Input Section Basics::	Input section basics
4920* Input Section Wildcards::	Input section wildcard patterns
4921* Input Section Common::	Input section for common symbols
4922* Input Section Keep::		Input section and garbage collection
4923* Input Section Example::	Input section example
4924@end menu
4925
4926@node Input Section Basics
4927@subsubsection Input Section Basics
4928@cindex input section basics
4929An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4930by a list of section names in parentheses.
4931
4932The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4933describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4934
4935The most common input section description is to include all input
4936sections with a particular name in the output section.  For example, to
4937include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4938@smallexample
4939*(.text)
4940@end smallexample
4941@noindent
4942Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name.  To exclude a list
4943@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4944of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4945match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list.  For
4946example:
4947@smallexample
4948EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4949@end smallexample
4950@noindent
4951will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4952and @file{otherfile.o} to be included.  The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4953placed inside the section list, for example:
4954@smallexample
4955*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4956@end smallexample
4957@noindent
4958The result of this is identically to the previous example.  Supporting
4959two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4960more than one section, as described below.
4961
4962There are two ways to include more than one section:
4963@smallexample
4964*(.text .rdata)
4965*(.text) *(.rdata)
4966@end smallexample
4967@noindent
4968The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4969@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section.  In the
4970first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4971they are found in the linker input.  In the second example, all
4972@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4973@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4974
4975When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4976is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4977immediately following section, for example:
4978@smallexample
4979*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4980@end smallexample
4981@noindent
4982will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4983@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4984from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included.  To
4985exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4986could be modified to:
4987@smallexample
4988*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4989@end smallexample
4990@noindent
4991Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4992before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4993all sections.  Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4994@smallexample
4995EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4996@end smallexample
4997
4998You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4999You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5000needs to be at a particular location in memory.  For example:
5001@smallexample
5002data.o(.data)
5003@end smallexample
5004
5005To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5006of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5007
5008Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5009
5010@smallexample
5011@group
5012SECTIONS @{
5013  .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5014  .text2 :  @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5015@}
5016@end group
5017@end smallexample
5018
5019In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5020input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5021@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set.  The output section
5022@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5023whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5024
5025You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5026matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5027with no whitespace around the colon.
5028
5029@table @samp
5030@item archive:file
5031matches file within archive
5032@item archive:
5033matches the whole archive
5034@item :file
5035matches file but not one in an archive
5036@end table
5037
5038Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5039wildcards.  On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5040single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5041@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5042within an archive called @samp{c}.  @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5043also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5044other linker script contexts.  For instance, you cannot extract a file
5045from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5046command.
5047
5048If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5049the input file will be included in the output section.  This is not
5050commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion.  For example:
5051@smallexample
5052data.o
5053@end smallexample
5054
5055When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5056and does not contain any wild card
5057characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5058name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command.  If you
5059did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5060though it appeared on the command line.  Note that this differs from an
5061@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5062the archive search path.
5063
5064@node Input Section Wildcards
5065@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5066@cindex input section wildcards
5067@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5068@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5069@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5070In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5071name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5072
5073The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5074pattern for the file name.
5075
5076The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5077
5078@table @samp
5079@item *
5080matches any number of characters
5081@item ?
5082matches any single character
5083@item [@var{chars}]
5084matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5085character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5086@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5087@item \
5088quotes the following character
5089@end table
5090
5091File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5092specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command.  The linker
5093does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5094
5095If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5096appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5097will use the first match in the linker script.  For example, this
5098sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5099@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5100@smallexample
5101.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5102.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5103@end smallexample
5104
5105@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5106Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5107in the order in which they are seen during the link.  You can change
5108this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5109pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}).  When the
5110@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5111into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5112
5113@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5114@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5115@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5116alignment before placing them in the output file.  Placing larger
5117alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5118needed.
5119
5120@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5121@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5122@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5123numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5124section name before placing them in the output file.  In
5125@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5126the init_priority.  In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5127@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5128
5129@cindex SORT
5130@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5131
5132When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5133can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5134
5135@enumerate
5136@item
5137@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5138It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5139sections have the same name.
5140@item
5141@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5142It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5143sections have the same alignment.
5144@item
5145@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5146treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5147@item
5148@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5149is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5150@item
5151All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5152@end enumerate
5153
5154When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5155section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5156takes precedence over the command-line option.
5157
5158If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5159command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5160treated as nested sorting command.
5161
5162@enumerate
5163@item
5164@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5165@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5166@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5167@item
5168@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5169@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5170@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5171@end enumerate
5172
5173If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5174command-line option will be ignored.
5175
5176@cindex SORT_NONE
5177@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5178section sorting option.
5179
5180If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5181@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file.  The map file shows
5182precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5183
5184This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5185files.  This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5186sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5187The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5188with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5189linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5190@smallexample
5191@group
5192SECTIONS @{
5193  .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5194  .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5195  .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5196  .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5197@}
5198@end group
5199@end smallexample
5200
5201@node Input Section Common
5202@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5203@cindex common symbol placement
5204@cindex uninitialized data placement
5205A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5206file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section.  The
5207linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5208named @samp{COMMON}.
5209
5210You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5211other input sections.  You can use this to place common symbols from a
5212particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5213input files are placed in another section.
5214
5215In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5216@samp{.bss} section in the output file.  For example:
5217@smallexample
5218.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5219@end smallexample
5220
5221@cindex scommon section
5222@cindex small common symbols
5223Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol.  For
5224example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5225symbols and small common symbols.  In this case, the linker will use a
5226different special section name for other types of common symbols.  In
5227the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5228symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols.  This permits you
5229to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5230locations.
5231
5232@cindex [COMMON]
5233You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts.  This
5234notation is now considered obsolete.  It is equivalent to
5235@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5236
5237@node Input Section Keep
5238@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5239@cindex KEEP
5240@cindex garbage collection
5241When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5242it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5243This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5244with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5245@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5246
5247@node Input Section Example
5248@subsubsection Input Section Example
5249The following example is a complete linker script.  It tells the linker
5250to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5251start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5252@samp{0x10000}.  All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5253follows immediately, in the same output section.  All of section
5254@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5255@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5256All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5257files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5258
5259@smallexample
5260@group
5261SECTIONS @{
5262  outputa 0x10000 :
5263    @{
5264    all.o
5265    foo.o (.input1)
5266    @}
5267@end group
5268@group
5269  outputb :
5270    @{
5271    foo.o (.input2)
5272    foo1.o (.input1)
5273    @}
5274@end group
5275@group
5276  outputc :
5277    @{
5278    *(.input1)
5279    *(.input2)
5280    @}
5281@}
5282@end group
5283@end smallexample
5284
5285If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5286and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5287automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5288__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section.  These
5289indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5290respectively.  Note: most section names are not representable as
5291C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5292
5293@node Output Section Data
5294@subsection Output Section Data
5295@cindex data
5296@cindex section data
5297@cindex output section data
5298@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5299@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5300@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5301@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5302@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5303You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5304@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5305an output section command.  Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5306parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}).  The
5307value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5308counter.
5309
5310The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5311store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively).  After storing the
5312bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5313stored.
5314
5315For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5316of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5317@smallexample
5318BYTE(1)
5319LONG(addr)
5320@end smallexample
5321
5322When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5323same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value.  When both host and
5324target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits.  In this case
5325@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5326@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5327
5328If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5329which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5330When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5331true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5332endianness of the first input object file.
5333
5334Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5335between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5336@smallexample
5337SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5338@end smallexample
5339whereas this will work:
5340@smallexample
5341SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5342@end smallexample
5343
5344@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5345@cindex holes, filling
5346@cindex unspecified memory
5347You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5348current section.  It is followed by an expression in parentheses.  Any
5349otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5350gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5351with the value of the expression, repeated as
5352necessary.  A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5353point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5354than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5355different parts of an output section.
5356
5357This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5358value @samp{0x90}:
5359@smallexample
5360FILL(0x90909090)
5361@end smallexample
5362
5363The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5364section attribute, but it only affects the
5365part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5366entire section.  If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5367precedence.  @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5368expression.
5369
5370@node Output Section Keywords
5371@subsection Output Section Keywords
5372There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5373commands.
5374
5375@table @code
5376@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5377@cindex input filename symbols
5378@cindex filename symbols
5379@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5380The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5381The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5382file.  The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5383the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5384
5385This is conventional for the a.out object file format.  It is not
5386normally used for any other object file format.
5387
5388@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5389@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5390@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5391@item CONSTRUCTORS
5392When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5393unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5394destructors.  When linking object file formats which do not support
5395arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5396automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5397For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5398linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5399@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears.  The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5400ignored for other object file formats.
5401
5402The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5403constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5404Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5405the start and end of the global destructors.  The
5406first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5407of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word.  The
5408compiler must arrange to actually run the code.  For these object file
5409formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5410@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5411the startup code for @code{main}.  @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5412destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5413@code{exit}.
5414
5415For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5416arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5417addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5418and @code{.dtors} sections.  Placing the following sequence into your
5419linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5420runtime code expects to see.
5421
5422@smallexample
5423      __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5424      LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5425      *(.ctors)
5426      LONG(0)
5427      __CTOR_END__ = .;
5428      __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5429      LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5430      *(.dtors)
5431      LONG(0)
5432      __DTOR_END__ = .;
5433@end smallexample
5434
5435If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5436which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5437are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5438are executed in the correct order.  When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5439command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead.  When using the
5440@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5441@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5442@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5443
5444Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5445and you will not need to concern yourself with them.  However, you may
5446need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5447scripts.
5448
5449@end table
5450
5451@node Output Section Discarding
5452@subsection Output Section Discarding
5453@cindex discarding sections
5454@cindex sections, discarding
5455@cindex removing sections
5456The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5457This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5458may not be present in any of the input files.  For example:
5459@smallexample
5460.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5461@end smallexample
5462@noindent
5463will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5464@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5465sections are not all empty.  Other link script directives that allocate
5466space in an output section will also create the output section.  So
5467too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5468space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5469@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5470@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5471This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5472
5473The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5474on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5475symbols in the output section.  In that case the linker will obey
5476the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5477section is discarded.
5478
5479@cindex /DISCARD/
5480The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5481input sections.  Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5482section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5483
5484This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5485@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5486garbage collection.
5487
5488Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5489discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5490members which are not being discarded.  This is deliberate.
5491Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5492
5493@node Output Section Attributes
5494@subsection Output Section Attributes
5495@cindex output section attributes
5496We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5497like this:
5498
5499@smallexample
5500@group
5501@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5502  [AT(@var{lma})]
5503  [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5504  [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5505  [@var{constraint}]
5506  @{
5507    @var{output-section-command}
5508    @var{output-section-command}
5509    @dots{}
5510  @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5511@end group
5512@end smallexample
5513
5514We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5515@var{output-section-command}.  In this section we will describe the
5516remaining section attributes.
5517
5518@menu
5519* Output Section Type::		Output section type
5520* Output Section LMA::		Output section LMA
5521* Forced Output Alignment::	Forced Output Alignment
5522* Forced Input Alignment::	Forced Input Alignment
5523* Output Section Constraint::   Output section constraint
5524* Output Section Region::	Output section region
5525* Output Section Phdr::		Output section phdr
5526* Output Section Fill::		Output section fill
5527@end menu
5528
5529@node Output Section Type
5530@subsubsection Output Section Type
5531Each output section may have a type.  The type is a keyword in
5532parentheses.  The following types are defined:
5533
5534@table @code
5535@item NOLOAD
5536The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5537loaded into memory when the program is run.
5538@item READONLY
5539The section should be marked as read-only.
5540@item DSECT
5541@item COPY
5542@item INFO
5543@item OVERLAY
5544These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5545rarely used.  They all have the same effect: the section should be
5546marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5547section when the program is run.
5548@item TYPE = @var{type}
5549Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5550output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5551@code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
5552@code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5553for @var{type}.  It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5554special requirements of the section type are met.
5555@item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5556This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5557type specified by @var{type}.
5558@end table
5559
5560@kindex NOLOAD
5561@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5562@cindex loading, preventing
5563The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5564the input sections which map into it.  You can override this by using
5565the section type.  For example, in the script sample below, the
5566@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5567need to be loaded when the program is run.
5568@smallexample
5569@group
5570SECTIONS @{
5571  ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5572  @dots{}
5573@}
5574@end group
5575@end smallexample
5576
5577@node Output Section LMA
5578@subsubsection Output Section LMA
5579@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5580@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5581@cindex load address
5582@cindex section load address
5583Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5584@ref{Basic Script Concepts}.  The virtual address is specified by the
5585@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier.  The load address is
5586specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords.  Specifying a load
5587address is optional.
5588
5589The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument.  This
5590specifies the exact load address of the section.  The @code{AT>} keyword
5591takes the name of a memory region as an argument.  @xref{MEMORY}.  The
5592load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5593region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5594
5595If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5596section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5597load address:
5598
5599@itemize @bullet
5600@item
5601If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5602the LMA address as well.
5603
5604@item
5605If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5606
5607@item
5608Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5609with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5610section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5611VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5612the last section in the located region.
5613
5614@item
5615If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5616that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5617
5618@item
5619If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5620section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5621@end itemize
5622
5623@cindex ROM initialized data
5624@cindex initialized data in ROM
5625This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image.  For
5626example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5627called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5628@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5629even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5630uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}.  The symbol @code{_data} is
5631defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5632counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5633
5634@smallexample
5635@group
5636SECTIONS
5637  @{
5638  .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5639  .mdata 0x2000 :
5640    AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5641    @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ;  @}
5642  .bss 0x3000 :
5643    @{ _bstart = . ;  *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5644@}
5645@end group
5646@end smallexample
5647
5648The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5649this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5650the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address.  Notice
5651how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5652script.
5653
5654@smallexample
5655@group
5656extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5657char *src = &_etext;
5658char *dst = &_data;
5659
5660/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it.  */
5661while (dst < &_edata)
5662  *dst++ = *src++;
5663
5664/* Zero bss.  */
5665for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5666  *dst = 0;
5667@end group
5668@end smallexample
5669
5670@node Forced Output Alignment
5671@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5672@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5673@cindex forcing output section alignment
5674@cindex output section alignment
5675You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN.  As an
5676alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5677intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5678
5679@node Forced Input Alignment
5680@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5681@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5682@cindex forcing input section alignment
5683@cindex input section alignment
5684You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5685SUBALIGN.  The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5686sections, whether larger or smaller.
5687
5688@node Output Section Constraint
5689@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5690@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5691@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5692@cindex constraints on output sections
5693You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5694of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5695read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5696@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5697
5698@node Output Section Region
5699@subsubsection Output Section Region
5700@kindex >@var{region}
5701@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5702@cindex memory regions and sections
5703You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5704using @samp{>@var{region}}.  @xref{MEMORY}.
5705
5706Here is a simple example:
5707@smallexample
5708@group
5709MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5710SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5711@end group
5712@end smallexample
5713
5714@node Output Section Phdr
5715@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5716@kindex :@var{phdr}
5717@cindex section, assigning to program header
5718@cindex program headers and sections
5719You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5720using @samp{:@var{phdr}}.  @xref{PHDRS}.  If a section is assigned to
5721one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5722assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5723@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier.  You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5724linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5725
5726Here is a simple example:
5727@smallexample
5728@group
5729PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5730SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5731@end group
5732@end smallexample
5733
5734@node Output Section Fill
5735@subsubsection Output Section Fill
5736@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5737@cindex section fill pattern
5738@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5739You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5740@samp{=@var{fillexp}}.  @var{fillexp} is an expression
5741(@pxref{Expressions}).  Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5742within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5743alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5744necessary.  If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5745of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5746an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5747fill pattern;  Leading zeros become part of the pattern too.  For all
5748other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5749pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5750expression.  In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5751
5752You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5753output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5754
5755Here is a simple example:
5756@smallexample
5757@group
5758SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5759@end group
5760@end smallexample
5761
5762@node Overlay Description
5763@subsection Overlay Description
5764@kindex OVERLAY
5765@cindex overlays
5766An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5767are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5768the same memory address.  At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5769copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5770required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits.  This approach
5771can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5772than another.
5773
5774Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command.  The
5775@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5776output section description.  The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5777command is as follows:
5778@smallexample
5779@group
5780OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5781  @{
5782    @var{secname1}
5783      @{
5784        @var{output-section-command}
5785        @var{output-section-command}
5786        @dots{}
5787      @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5788    @var{secname2}
5789      @{
5790        @var{output-section-command}
5791        @var{output-section-command}
5792        @dots{}
5793      @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5794    @dots{}
5795  @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5796@end group
5797@end smallexample
5798
5799Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5800section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above).  The
5801section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5802those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5803except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5804sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5805
5806The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5807the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5808
5809The sections are all defined with the same starting address.  The load
5810addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5811memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5812whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5813and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5814and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5815
5816If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5817references among the sections, the linker will report an error.  Since
5818the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5819sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5820@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5821
5822For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5823provides two symbols.  The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5824defined as the starting load address of the section.  The symbol
5825@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5826the section.  Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5827within C identifiers are removed.  C (or assembler) code may use these
5828symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5829
5830At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5831the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5832
5833Here is an example.  Remember that this would appear inside a
5834@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5835@smallexample
5836@group
5837  OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5838   @{
5839     .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5840     .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5841   @}
5842@end group
5843@end smallexample
5844@noindent
5845This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5846address 0x1000.  @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5847@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}.  The
5848following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5849@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5850@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5851
5852C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5853like the following.
5854
5855@smallexample
5856@group
5857  extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5858  memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5859          &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5860@end group
5861@end smallexample
5862
5863Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5864everything it does can be done using the more basic commands.  The above
5865example could have been written identically as follows.
5866
5867@smallexample
5868@group
5869  .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5870  PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5871  PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5872  .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5873  PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5874  PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5875  . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5876@end group
5877@end smallexample
5878
5879@node MEMORY
5880@section MEMORY Command
5881@kindex MEMORY
5882@cindex memory regions
5883@cindex regions of memory
5884@cindex allocating memory
5885@cindex discontinuous memory
5886The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5887memory.  You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5888
5889The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5890memory in the target.  You can use it to describe which memory regions
5891may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid.  You
5892can then assign sections to particular memory regions.  The linker will
5893set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5894regions that become too full.  The linker will not shuffle sections
5895around to fit into the available regions.
5896
5897A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5898however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5899specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command.  The syntax for
5900@code{MEMORY} is:
5901@smallexample
5902@group
5903MEMORY
5904  @{
5905    @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5906    @dots{}
5907  @}
5908@end group
5909@end smallexample
5910
5911The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5912region.  The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5913Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5914with symbol names, file names, or section names.  Each memory region
5915must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command.  However you can
5916add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5917command.
5918
5919@cindex memory region attributes
5920The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5921whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5922not explicitly mapped in the linker script.  As described in
5923@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5924section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5925the input section.  If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5926them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5927
5928The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5929@table @samp
5930@item R
5931Read-only section
5932@item W
5933Read/write section
5934@item X
5935Executable section
5936@item A
5937Allocatable section
5938@item I
5939Initialized section
5940@item L
5941Same as @samp{I}
5942@item !
5943Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5944@end table
5945
5946If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5947@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region.  The @samp{!}
5948attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5949unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5950not match any of the attributes listed afterwards.  Thus an attribute
5951string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5952or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5953the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5954
5955@kindex ORIGIN =
5956@kindex o =
5957@kindex org =
5958The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5959the memory region.  The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5960cannot involve any symbols.  The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5961abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5962@code{ORG}).
5963
5964@kindex LENGTH =
5965@kindex len =
5966@kindex l =
5967The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5968region.  As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5969be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant.  The keyword
5970@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5971
5972In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5973available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5974and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes.  The
5975linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5976is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5977or executable.  The linker will place other sections which are not
5978explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5979region.
5980
5981@smallexample
5982@group
5983MEMORY
5984  @{
5985    rom (rx)  : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5986    ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5987  @}
5988@end group
5989@end smallexample
5990
5991Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5992specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5993@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute.  For example, if you have
5994a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5995output section definition.  @xref{Output Section Region}.  If no address
5996was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5997the next available address within the memory region.  If the combined
5998output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5999region, the linker will issue an error message.
6000
6001It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
6002expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
6003@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6004
6005@smallexample
6006@group
6007  _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
6008@end group
6009@end smallexample
6010
6011@node PHDRS
6012@section PHDRS Command
6013@kindex PHDRS
6014@cindex program headers
6015@cindex ELF program headers
6016@cindex program segments
6017@cindex segments, ELF
6018The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6019@dfn{segments}.  The program headers describe how the program should be
6020loaded into memory.  You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6021program with the @samp{-p} option.
6022
6023When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6024reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6025program.  This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6026This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6027interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6028
6029The linker will create reasonable program headers by default.  However,
6030in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6031precisely.  You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose.  When
6032the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6033not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6034
6035The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6036generating an ELF output file.  In other cases, the linker will simply
6037ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6038
6039This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command.  The words @code{PHDRS},
6040@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6041
6042@smallexample
6043@group
6044PHDRS
6045@{
6046  @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6047        [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6048@}
6049@end group
6050@end smallexample
6051
6052The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6053of the linker script.  It is not put into the output file.  Program
6054header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6055with symbol names, file names, or section names.  Each program header
6056must have a distinct name.  The headers are processed in order and it
6057is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
6058
6059Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6060system loader will load from the file.  In the linker script, you
6061specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6062sections in the segments.  You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6063attribute to place a section in a particular segment.  @xref{Output
6064Section Phdr}.
6065
6066It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment.  This
6067merely implies that one segment of memory contains another.  You may
6068repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6069contain the section.
6070
6071If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6072then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6073not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments.  This is for
6074convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6075placed in a single segment.  You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6076default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6077segment at all.
6078
6079@kindex FILEHDR
6080@kindex PHDRS
6081You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6082the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6083The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6084file header.  The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6085include the ELF program headers themselves.  If applied to a loadable
6086segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6087these keywords.
6088
6089The @var{type} may be one of the following.  The numbers indicate the
6090value of the keyword.
6091
6092@table @asis
6093@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6094Indicates an unused program header.
6095
6096@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6097Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6098the file.
6099
6100@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6101Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6102
6103@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6104Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6105found.
6106
6107@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6108Indicates a segment holding note information.
6109
6110@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6111A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6112ABI.
6113
6114@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6115Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6116
6117@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6118Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6119
6120@item @var{expression}
6121An expression giving the numeric type of the program header.  This may
6122be used for types not defined above.
6123@end table
6124
6125You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6126in memory by using an @code{AT} expression.  This is identical to the
6127@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6128Section LMA}).  The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6129output section attribute.
6130
6131The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6132which comprise the segment.  You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6133explicitly specify the segment flags.  The value of @var{flags} must be
6134an integer.  It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6135header.
6136
6137Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}.  This shows a typical set of program
6138headers used on a native ELF system.
6139
6140@example
6141@group
6142PHDRS
6143@{
6144  headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6145  interp PT_INTERP ;
6146  text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6147  data PT_LOAD ;
6148  dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6149@}
6150
6151SECTIONS
6152@{
6153  . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6154  .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6155  .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6156  .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6157  @dots{}
6158  . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6159  .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6160  .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6161  @dots{}
6162@}
6163@end group
6164@end example
6165
6166@node VERSION
6167@section VERSION Command
6168@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6169@cindex symbol versions
6170@cindex version script
6171@cindex versions of symbols
6172The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF.  Symbol versions are
6173only useful when using shared libraries.  The dynamic linker can use
6174symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6175a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6176shared library.
6177
6178You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6179you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script.  You can
6180also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6181
6182The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6183@smallexample
6184VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6185@end smallexample
6186
6187The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6188Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5.  The version script defines a tree of
6189version nodes.  You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6190version script.  You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6191version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6192scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6193library.
6194
6195The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6196examples.
6197
6198@smallexample
6199VERS_1.1 @{
6200	 global:
6201		 foo1;
6202	 local:
6203		 old*;
6204		 original*;
6205		 new*;
6206@};
6207
6208VERS_1.2 @{
6209		 foo2;
6210@} VERS_1.1;
6211
6212VERS_2.0 @{
6213		 bar1; bar2;
6214	 extern "C++" @{
6215		 ns::*;
6216		 "f(int, double)";
6217	 @};
6218@} VERS_1.2;
6219@end smallexample
6220
6221This example version script defines three version nodes.  The first
6222version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6223The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}.  It reduces
6224a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6225of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6226symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6227is matched.  The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6228in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6229However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6230name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6231
6232Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}.  This node
6233depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}.  The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6234to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6235
6236Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}.  This node
6237depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}.  The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6238and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6239
6240When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6241specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6242unspecified base version of the library.  You can bind all otherwise
6243unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6244somewhere in the version script.  Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6245wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node.  Global
6246wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6247set exported for an old version.  That's wrong since older versions
6248ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6249
6250The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6251they might suggest to the person reading them.  The @samp{2.0} version
6252could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6253However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6254
6255Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6256in the version script.  Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6257symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6258won't.
6259
6260@smallexample
6261@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6262@end smallexample
6263
6264When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6265symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6266requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6267shared library it is linked against.  Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6268loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6269linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6270application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols.  In this
6271way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6272all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6273search for each symbol reference.
6274
6275The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6276doing minor version checking that SunOS does.  The fundamental problem
6277that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6278functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6279the application starts up.  If a shared library is out of date, a
6280required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6281that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail.  With symbol
6282versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6283the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6284
6285There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach.  The
6286first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6287source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6288script.  This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6289maintainer.  You can do this by putting something like:
6290@smallexample
6291__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6292@end smallexample
6293@noindent
6294in the C source file.  This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6295be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6296The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6297@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6298takes precedence over a version script.
6299
6300The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6301function to appear in a given shared library.  In this way you can make
6302an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6303version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6304linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6305
6306To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6307source file.  Here is an example:
6308
6309@smallexample
6310__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6311__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6312__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6313__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6314@end smallexample
6315
6316In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6317unspecified base version of the symbol.  The source file that contains this
6318example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6319@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6320
6321When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6322some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6323this symbol will be bound.  You can do this with the
6324@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive.  You can only
6325declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6326you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6327
6328If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6329within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6330(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6331specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6332
6333You can also specify the language in the version script:
6334
6335@smallexample
6336VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6337@end smallexample
6338
6339The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6340The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6341demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6342patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}.  The default
6343@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6344
6345Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters.  As
6346described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6347or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly.  In
6348the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6349whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6350cause a mismatch.  As the exact string generated by the demangler
6351might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6352should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6353expect when you upgrade.
6354
6355@node Expressions
6356@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6357@cindex expressions
6358@cindex arithmetic
6359The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6360that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6361places to resolve syntactic ambiguities.  All expressions are
6362evaluated as integers.  All expressions are evaluated in the same
6363size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6364otherwise 64 bits.
6365
6366You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6367
6368The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6369expressions.
6370
6371@menu
6372* Constants::			Constants
6373* Symbolic Constants::          Symbolic constants
6374* Symbols::			Symbol Names
6375* Orphan Sections::		Orphan Sections
6376* Location Counter::		The Location Counter
6377* Operators::			Operators
6378* Evaluation::			Evaluation
6379* Expression Section::		The Section of an Expression
6380* Builtin Functions::		Builtin Functions
6381@end menu
6382
6383@node Constants
6384@subsection Constants
6385@cindex integer notation
6386@cindex constants in linker scripts
6387All constants are integers.
6388
6389As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6390octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6391hexadecimal.  Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6392@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6393@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal.  Any integer
6394value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6395
6396@cindex scaled integers
6397@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6398@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6399@cindex suffixes for integers
6400@cindex integer suffixes
6401In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6402constant by
6403@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6404@ifnottex
6405@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6406@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6407@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6408@end ifnottex
6409@tex
6410${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6411@end tex
6412@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6413respectively.  For example, the following
6414all refer to the same quantity:
6415
6416@smallexample
6417_fourk_1 = 4K;
6418_fourk_2 = 4096;
6419_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6420_fourk_4 = 10000o;
6421@end smallexample
6422
6423Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6424conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6425
6426@node Symbolic Constants
6427@subsection Symbolic Constants
6428@cindex symbolic constants
6429@kindex CONSTANT
6430It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6431the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6432
6433@table @code
6434@item MAXPAGESIZE
6435@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6436The target's maximum page size.
6437
6438@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6439@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6440The target's default page size.
6441@end table
6442
6443So for example:
6444
6445@smallexample
6446  .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6447@end smallexample
6448
6449will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6450supported by the target.
6451
6452@node Symbols
6453@subsection Symbol Names
6454@cindex symbol names
6455@cindex names
6456@cindex quoted symbol names
6457@kindex "
6458Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6459and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6460Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords.  You can
6461specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6462keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6463@smallexample
6464"SECTION" = 9;
6465"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6466@end smallexample
6467
6468Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6469to delimit symbols with spaces.  For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6470whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6471
6472@node Orphan Sections
6473@subsection Orphan Sections
6474@cindex orphan
6475Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6476are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6477script.  The linker will still copy these sections into the
6478output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6479in which to place the orphaned input section.
6480
6481If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6482an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6483placed at the end of that output section.
6484
6485If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6486sections will be created.  Each new output section will have the same
6487name as the orphan section placed within it.  If there are multiple
6488orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6489one new output section.
6490
6491If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6492then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6493in relation to existing output sections.  On most modern targets, the
6494linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6495attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc.  If no
6496sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6497support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6498
6499The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6500(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6501output sections an orphan is placed in.
6502
6503@node Location Counter
6504@subsection The Location Counter
6505@kindex .
6506@cindex dot
6507@cindex location counter
6508@cindex current output location
6509The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6510current output location counter.  Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6511location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6512within a @code{SECTIONS} command.  The @code{.} symbol may appear
6513anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6514
6515@cindex holes
6516Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6517moved.  This may be used to create holes in the output section.  The
6518location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6519and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6520doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6521
6522@smallexample
6523SECTIONS
6524@{
6525  output :
6526    @{
6527      file1(.text)
6528      . = . + 1000;
6529      file2(.text)
6530      . += 1000;
6531      file3(.text)
6532    @} = 0x12345678;
6533@}
6534@end smallexample
6535@noindent
6536In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6537located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}.  It is
6538followed by a 1000 byte gap.  Then the @samp{.text} section from
6539@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6540@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}.  The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6541specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6542
6543@cindex dot inside sections
6544Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6545current containing object.  Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6546statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6547absolute address.  If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6548however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6549not an absolute address.  Thus in a script like this:
6550
6551@smallexample
6552SECTIONS
6553@{
6554    . = 0x100
6555    .text: @{
6556      *(.text)
6557      . = 0x200
6558    @}
6559    . = 0x500
6560    .data: @{
6561      *(.data)
6562      . += 0x600
6563    @}
6564@}
6565@end smallexample
6566
6567The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6568and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6569the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area.  (If there is too
6570much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6571move @code{.} backwards).  The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6572and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6573the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6574the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6575
6576@cindex dot outside sections
6577Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6578output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6579needs to place orphan sections.  For example, given the following:
6580
6581@smallexample
6582SECTIONS
6583@{
6584    start_of_text = . ;
6585    .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6586    end_of_text = . ;
6587
6588    start_of_data = . ;
6589    .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6590    end_of_data = . ;
6591@}
6592@end smallexample
6593
6594If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6595not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6596between @code{.text} and @code{.data}.  You might think the linker
6597should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6598blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker.  As well,
6599the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6600sections.  Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6601statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6602special case of an assignment to @code{.}.  I.e., the linker will
6603place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6604as follows:
6605
6606@smallexample
6607SECTIONS
6608@{
6609    start_of_text = . ;
6610    .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6611    end_of_text = . ;
6612
6613    start_of_data = . ;
6614    .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6615    .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6616    end_of_data = . ;
6617@}
6618@end smallexample
6619
6620This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6621@code{start_of_data}.  One way to influence the orphan section
6622placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6623assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6624a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6625section.  So you could write:
6626
6627@smallexample
6628SECTIONS
6629@{
6630    start_of_text = . ;
6631    .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6632    end_of_text = . ;
6633
6634    . = . ;
6635    start_of_data = . ;
6636    .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6637    end_of_data = . ;
6638@}
6639@end smallexample
6640
6641Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6642@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6643
6644@need 2000
6645@node Operators
6646@subsection Operators
6647@cindex operators for arithmetic
6648@cindex arithmetic operators
6649@cindex precedence in expressions
6650The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6651the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6652@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6653@ifnottex
6654@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6655@smallexample
6656precedence      associativity   Operators                Notes
6657(highest)
66581               left            !  -  ~                  (1)
66592               left            *  /  %
66603               left            +  -
66614               left            >>  <<
66625               left            ==  !=  >  <  <=  >=
66636               left            &
66647               left            |
66658               left            &&
66669               left            ||
666710              right           ? :
666811              right           &=  +=  -=  *=  /=       (2)
6669(lowest)
6670@end smallexample
6671Notes:
6672(1) Prefix operators
6673(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6674@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6675@end ifnottex
6676@tex
6677\vskip \baselineskip
6678%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6679\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6680\hrule
6681\halign
6682{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6683height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6684&Precedence&&  Associativity  &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6685height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6686\noalign{\hrule}
6687height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6688&highest&&&&&\cr
6689% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6690&1&&left&&\qquad-          \char'176\      !\qquad\dag&\cr
6691&2&&left&&*          /        \%&\cr
6692&3&&left&&+          -&\cr
6693&4&&left&&>>         <<&\cr
6694&5&&left&&==         !=       >      <      <=      >=&\cr
6695&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6696&7&&left&&|&\cr
6697&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6698&9&&left&&||&\cr
6699&10&&right&&?        :&\cr
6700&11&&right&&\qquad\&=      +=       -=     *=     /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6701&lowest&&&&&\cr
6702height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6703\hrule}
6704@end tex
6705@iftex
6706{
6707@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6708@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6709@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6710}
6711@end iftex
6712@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6713
6714@node Evaluation
6715@subsection Evaluation
6716@cindex lazy evaluation
6717@cindex expression evaluation order
6718The linker evaluates expressions lazily.  It only computes the value of
6719an expression when absolutely necessary.
6720
6721The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6722address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6723regions, in order to do any linking at all.  These values are computed
6724as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6725
6726However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6727until after storage allocation.  Such values are evaluated later, when
6728other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6729for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6730
6731The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6732assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6733allocation.
6734
6735Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6736@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6737
6738If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6739available, then an error results.  For example, a script like the
6740following
6741@smallexample
6742@group
6743SECTIONS
6744  @{
6745    .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6746      @{ *(.text) @}
6747  @}
6748@end group
6749@end smallexample
6750@noindent
6751will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6752address}.
6753
6754@node Expression Section
6755@subsection The Section of an Expression
6756@cindex expression sections
6757@cindex absolute expressions
6758@cindex relative expressions
6759@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6760@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6761@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6762Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute.  A section
6763relative symbol is relocatable.  If you request relocatable output
6764using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6765value of a section relative symbol.  On the other hand, an absolute
6766symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6767operations.
6768
6769Some terms in linker expressions are addresses.  This is true of
6770section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6771address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6772@code{SEGMENT_START}.  Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6773functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6774One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6775(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6776differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6777versions of @code{ld}.  Expressions appearing outside an output
6778section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6779Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6780absolute symbols as numbers.  If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6781given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6782everywhere.
6783
6784In the following simple example,
6785
6786@smallexample
6787@group
6788SECTIONS
6789  @{
6790    . = 0x100;
6791    __executable_start = 0x100;
6792    .data :
6793    @{
6794      . = 0x10;
6795      __data_start = 0x10;
6796      *(.data)
6797    @}
6798    @dots{}
6799  @}
6800@end group
6801@end smallexample
6802
6803both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6804address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6805@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6806section in the second two assignments.
6807
6808For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6809addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6810
6811@itemize @bullet
6812@item
6813Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6814operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6815absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6816@item
6817Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6818relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6819and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6820@item
6821Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6822in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6823address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6824before applying the operator.
6825@end itemize
6826
6827The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6828
6829@itemize @bullet
6830@item
6831An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6832@item
6833The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6834@item
6835The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6836relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6837(after above conversions) is also a number when
6838@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6839but an absolute address otherwise.
6840@item
6841The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6842relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6843section as the relative operand(s).
6844@item
6845The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6846conversions) is an absolute address.
6847@end itemize
6848
6849You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6850to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative.  For example, to
6851create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6852section @samp{.data}:
6853@smallexample
6854SECTIONS
6855  @{
6856    .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6857  @}
6858@end smallexample
6859@noindent
6860If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6861@samp{.data} section.
6862
6863Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6864particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6865
6866@node Builtin Functions
6867@subsection Builtin Functions
6868@cindex functions in expressions
6869The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6870use in linker script expressions.
6871
6872@table @code
6873@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6874@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6875@cindex expression, absolute
6876Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6877of the expression @var{exp}.  Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6878value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6879normally section relative.  @xref{Expression Section}.
6880
6881@item ADDR(@var{section})
6882@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6883@cindex section address in expression
6884Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}.  Your
6885script must previously have defined the location of that section.  In
6886the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6887@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6888@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6889the other two will be absolute:
6890@smallexample
6891@group
6892SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6893  .output1 :
6894    @{
6895    start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6896    @dots{}
6897    @}
6898  .output :
6899    @{
6900    symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6901    symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6902    @}
6903@dots{} @}
6904@end group
6905@end smallexample
6906
6907@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6908@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6909@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6910@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6911@cindex round up location counter
6912@cindex align location counter
6913@cindex round up expression
6914@cindex align expression
6915Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6916to the next @var{align} boundary.  The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6917doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6918arithmetic on it.  The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6919expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6920equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6921
6922Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6923next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6924variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6925input sections:
6926@smallexample
6927@group
6928SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6929  .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6930    *(.data)
6931    variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6932  @}
6933@dots{} @}
6934@end group
6935@end smallexample
6936@noindent
6937The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6938a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6939a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}).  The second use
6940of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6941
6942The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6943
6944@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6945@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6946@cindex section alignment
6947Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6948been allocated.  If the section has not been allocated when this is
6949evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6950the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6951value in that section.
6952@smallexample
6953@group
6954SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6955  .output @{
6956    LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6957    @dots{}
6958    @}
6959@dots{} @}
6960@end group
6961@end smallexample
6962
6963@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6964@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6965This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6966scripts.  It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6967section.
6968
6969@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6970@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6971This is equivalent to either
6972@smallexample
6973(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6974@end smallexample
6975or
6976@smallexample
6977(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6978 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6979@end smallexample
6980@noindent
6981depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6982for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6983@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6984If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6985memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6986bytes in the on-disk file.
6987
6988This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6989any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6990@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6991be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6992running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}.  Note however
6993that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6994page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6995
6996@noindent
6997Example:
6998@smallexample
6999  . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7000@end smallexample
7001
7002@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7003@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7004This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7005evaluation purposes.
7006
7007@smallexample
7008  . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7009@end smallexample
7010
7011@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7012@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7013This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
7014@samp{-z relro} option is used.
7015When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7016does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
7017@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7018argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}.  If present in the linker
7019script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
7020@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}.  Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7021padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7022section alignment.
7023
7024@smallexample
7025  . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7026@end smallexample
7027
7028@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7029@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7030@cindex symbol defaults
7031Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
7032defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7033return 0.  You can use this function to provide
7034default values for symbols.  For example, the following script fragment
7035shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7036the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7037existed, its value is preserved:
7038
7039@smallexample
7040@group
7041SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7042  .text : @{
7043    begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7044    @dots{}
7045  @}
7046  @dots{}
7047@}
7048@end group
7049@end smallexample
7050
7051@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7052@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7053Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7054
7055@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7056@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7057@cindex section load address in expression
7058Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}.  (@pxref{Output
7059Section LMA}).
7060
7061@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7062@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7063Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7064@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7065
7066@kindex MAX
7067@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7068Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7069
7070@kindex MIN
7071@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7072Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7073
7074@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7075@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7076@cindex unallocated address, next
7077Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7078This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7079use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7080output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7081
7082@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7083@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7084Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7085
7086@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7087@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7088Return the base address of the named @var{segment}.  If an explicit
7089value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7090@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7091will be @var{default}.  At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7092can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7093``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7094name.
7095
7096@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7097@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7098@cindex section size
7099Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7100been allocated.  If the section has not been allocated when this is
7101evaluated, the linker will report an error.  In the following example,
7102@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7103@smallexample
7104@group
7105SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7106  .output @{
7107    .start = . ;
7108    @dots{}
7109    .end = . ;
7110    @}
7111  symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7112  symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7113@dots{} @}
7114@end group
7115@end smallexample
7116
7117@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7118@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7119@cindex header size
7120Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers.  This is
7121information which appears at the start of the output file.  You can use
7122this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7123choose, to facilitate paging.
7124
7125@cindex not enough room for program headers
7126@cindex program headers, not enough room
7127When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7128@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7129number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7130addresses and sizes.  If the linker later discovers that it needs
7131additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7132room for program headers}.  To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7133the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7134script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7135you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7136command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7137@end table
7138
7139@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7140@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7141@cindex implicit linker scripts
7142If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7143an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7144linker script.  If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7145linker will report an error.
7146
7147An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7148
7149Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7150assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7151commands.
7152
7153Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7154at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7155read.  This can affect archive searching.
7156
7157@node Plugins
7158@chapter Linker Plugins
7159
7160@cindex plugins
7161@cindex linker plugins
7162The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7163For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7164support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7165
7166Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7167be added here later.
7168
7169@menu
7170* libdep Plugin::	Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7171@end menu
7172
7173@node libdep Plugin
7174@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7175@cindex static library dependencies
7176Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7177just of a collection of relocatable object files.  Later they evolved to
7178optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7179within a library.  There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7180rose to ascendance.
7181
7182One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7183multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7184dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7185library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7186referenced as well.  But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7187link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7188libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7189explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7190
7191The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7192to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7193plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time.  The
7194dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7195and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7196command line.  As such, the information can be written with any text
7197utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7198being used to create the archive.  The information is stored in an
7199archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7200
7201For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7202library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7203the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7204
7205@smallexample
7206-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7207@end smallexample
7208
7209@ifset GENERIC
7210@node Machine Dependent
7211@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7212
7213@cindex machine dependencies
7214@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7215sections describe them.  Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7216functionality are not listed.
7217
7218@menu
7219@ifset H8300
7220* H8/300::                      @command{ld} and the H8/300
7221@end ifset
7222@ifset M68HC11
7223* M68HC11/68HC12::		@code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7224@end ifset
7225@ifset ARM
7226* ARM::				@command{ld} and the ARM family
7227@end ifset
7228@ifset HPPA
7229* HPPA ELF32::                  @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7230@end ifset
7231@ifset M68K
7232* M68K::			@command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7233@end ifset
7234@ifset MIPS
7235* MIPS::			@command{ld} and the MIPS family
7236@end ifset
7237@ifset MMIX
7238* MMIX::			@command{ld} and MMIX
7239@end ifset
7240@ifset MSP430
7241* MSP430::			@command{ld} and MSP430
7242@end ifset
7243@ifset NDS32
7244* NDS32::			@command{ld} and NDS32
7245@end ifset
7246@ifset NIOSII
7247* Nios II::			@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7248@end ifset
7249@ifset POWERPC
7250* PowerPC ELF32::		@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7251@end ifset
7252@ifset POWERPC64
7253* PowerPC64 ELF64::		@command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7254@end ifset
7255@ifset S/390
7256* S/390 ELF::			@command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7257@end ifset
7258@ifset SPU
7259* SPU ELF::			@command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7260@end ifset
7261@ifset TICOFF
7262* TI COFF::                     @command{ld} and TI COFF
7263@end ifset
7264@ifset WIN32
7265* WIN32::                       @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7266@end ifset
7267@ifset XTENSA
7268* Xtensa::                      @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7269@end ifset
7270@end menu
7271@end ifset
7272
7273@ifset H8300
7274@ifclear GENERIC
7275@raisesections
7276@end ifclear
7277
7278@node H8/300
7279@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7280
7281@cindex H8/300 support
7282For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7283you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7284
7285@table @emph
7286@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7287@item relaxing address modes
7288@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7289targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7290program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7291respectively.
7292
7293@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7294@item synthesizing instructions
7295@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7296@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7297sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7298page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7299(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7300@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7301top page of memory).
7302
7303@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7304indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7305displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7306the 16-bit displacement form.  (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7307@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7308whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7309range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7310
7311@item bit manipulation instructions
7312@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7313biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7314which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7315page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7316(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7317@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7318the top page of memory).
7319
7320@item system control instructions
7321@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
732232 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7323changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7324(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7325@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7326the top page of memory).
7327@end table
7328
7329@ifclear GENERIC
7330@lowersections
7331@end ifclear
7332@end ifset
7333
7334@ifclear GENERIC
7335@ifset Renesas
7336@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7337@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7338@node Renesas
7339@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7340
7341@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7342H8/500, and SH chips.  No special features, commands, or command-line
7343options are required for these chips.
7344@end ifset
7345@end ifclear
7346
7347@ifset ARM
7348@ifclear GENERIC
7349@raisesections
7350@end ifclear
7351
7352@ifset M68HC11
7353@ifclear GENERIC
7354@raisesections
7355@end ifclear
7356
7357@node M68HC11/68HC12
7358@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7359
7360@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7361
7362@subsection Linker Relaxation
7363
7364For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7365optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7366
7367@table @emph
7368@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7369@item relaxing address modes
7370@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7371targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7372program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7373respectively.
7374
7375@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7376transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7377page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7378
7379@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7380When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7381of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7382addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7383@code{bset} instructions.
7384
7385@end table
7386
7387@subsection Trampoline Generation
7388
7389@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7390@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7391For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7392call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7393will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7394trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7395case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7396point to the function trampoline.
7397
7398@ifclear GENERIC
7399@lowersections
7400@end ifclear
7401@end ifset
7402
7403@node ARM
7404@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7405
7406@cindex ARM interworking support
7407@kindex --support-old-code
7408For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7409between ARM and Thumb code.  These stubs only work with code that has
7410been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7411line option.  If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7412libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7413option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7414given to the linker.  This will make it generate larger stub functions
7415which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code.  Note, however,
7416the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7417non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7418
7419@cindex thumb entry point
7420@cindex entry point, thumb
7421@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7422The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7423@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7424But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7425branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7426executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7427
7428@cindex PE import table prefixing
7429@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7430The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7431the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7432element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7433import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7434
7435@cindex BE8
7436@kindex --be8
7437The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7438executables.  This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7439objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7440option.  The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7441little-endian code.
7442
7443@cindex TARGET1
7444@kindex --target1-rel
7445@kindex --target1-abs
7446The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7447@samp{.init_array} section.  It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7448or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target.  The @samp{--target1-rel}
7449and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7450
7451@cindex TARGET2
7452@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7453The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7454@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation.  Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7455meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7456@table @samp
7457@item rel
7458@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7459@item abs
7460@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7461@item got-rel
7462@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7463@end table
7464
7465@cindex FIX_V4BX
7466@kindex --fix-v4bx
7467The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7468specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7469interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7470also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7471
7472In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7473linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7474@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7475
7476In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7477relocations are ignored.
7478
7479@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7480@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7481Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7482relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7483
7484@smallexample
7485TST rM, #1
7486MOVEQ PC, rM
7487BX Rn
7488@end smallexample
7489
7490This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7491and are still interworking safe.  Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7492condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7493
7494@cindex USE_BLX
7495@kindex --use-blx
7496The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7497BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7498situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7499code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7500each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7501
7502@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7503@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7504The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7505bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7506instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7507to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7508the support code can read the intended values.
7509
7510The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7511intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7512and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7513intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7514full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7515you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7516
7517If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7518enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7519@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7520mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7521vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7522@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7523
7524If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7525potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7526such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7527first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7528instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7529the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7530are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7531
7532@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7533@kindex --fix-arm1176
7534@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7535The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7536in certain ARM1176 processors.  The workaround is enabled by default if you
7537are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier.  It can be disabled
7538unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7539
7540Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7541Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7542http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7543
7544@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7545@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7546
7547The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7548workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7549the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx).  When accessing
7550off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7551the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort.  These are only
7552core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7553integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7554VPOP.  Stores are not affected.
7555
7556The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7557necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7558
7559The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7560@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}.  If you know you are using buggy
7561STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7562linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7563@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7564
7565If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7566potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7567such sequence which may trigger the erratum.  The veneer consists in a
7568replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7569branch back to the subsequent instruction.  The original instruction is
7570then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7571
7572The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7573the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7574
7575The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7576they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7577there.  In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7578occurs.
7579
7580The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7581PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7582large.  In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7583cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7584occurs.
7585
7586@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7587@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7588The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7589warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7590enumeration size attributes.  For example, with this switch enabled,
7591linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7592using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7593not be diagnosed.
7594
7595@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7596@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7597The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7598warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7599@code{wchar_t} size attributes.  For example, with this switch enabled,
7600linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7601using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7602
7603@cindex PIC_VENEER
7604@kindex --pic-veneer
7605The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7606ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7607is not PIC.  This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7608@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7609
7610@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7611@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7612The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7613code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7614perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away.  The
7615placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7616controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7617The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7618duplicate stubs, increasing the code size.  The linker will try to
7619group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7620code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7621where they should be placed.
7622
7623The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7624@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7625placed.  If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7626branch that needs them.  If it is positive then the stubs can be
7627placed either before or after the branches that need them.  If the
7628value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7629exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7630A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7631linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7632from the input sections.
7633
7634The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7635@samp{N = +1}.
7636
7637Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7638only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7639otherwise.
7640
7641@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7642@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7643@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7644The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors.  The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile.  It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7645
7646The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code.  Please contact ARM for further details.
7647
7648@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7649@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7650@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7651The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors.  The workaround is disabled by default.  It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7652
7653Please contact ARM for further details.
7654
7655@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7656@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7657@cindex Merging exidx entries
7658The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7659
7660@kindex --long-plt
7661@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7662The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7663which support up to 4Gb of code.  The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7664entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7665
7666@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7667@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7668The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7669link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7670
7671@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7672All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7673Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7674@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7675veneers in memory.
7676
7677@kindex --cmse-implib
7678@cindex Secure gateway import library
7679The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7680specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7681secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7682executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7683
7684@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7685@cindex Input import library
7686The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7687must keep the same address in the executable being produced.  A warning is
7688given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7689in the executable that should be listed in its import library.  Otherwise, if
7690@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7691library.  A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7692library have disappeared from the executable.  This option is only effective
7693for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7694specified.
7695
7696@ifclear GENERIC
7697@lowersections
7698@end ifclear
7699@end ifset
7700
7701@ifset HPPA
7702@ifclear GENERIC
7703@raisesections
7704@end ifclear
7705
7706@node HPPA ELF32
7707@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7708@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7709@kindex --multi-subspace
7710When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7711import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7712The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7713stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7714multiple sub-spaces.
7715
7716@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7717@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7718Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7719stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7720@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7721sections handled by one stub section.  Since branch offsets are signed,
7722a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7723the stub section, and one group after it.  However, when using
7724conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7725prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7726A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7727branches to stubs always use a negative offset.  Two special values of
7728@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}.  These both instruct
7729@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7730detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7731positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7732
7733Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections.  A
7734single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7735create a larger group (of one section).  If input sections are too
7736large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7737
7738@ifclear GENERIC
7739@lowersections
7740@end ifclear
7741@end ifset
7742
7743@ifset M68K
7744@ifclear GENERIC
7745@raisesections
7746@end ifclear
7747
7748@node M68K
7749@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7750
7751@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7752@kindex --got=@var{type}
7753The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7754The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7755@samp{target}.  When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7756the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7757@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7758entries only at non-negative offsets.
7759@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7760entries at both negative and positive offsets.  Not all environments
7761support such GOTs.
7762@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7763output file.  All GOT references from a single input object
7764file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7765files might access different GOTs.  Not all environments support such GOTs.
7766
7767@ifclear GENERIC
7768@lowersections
7769@end ifclear
7770@end ifset
7771
7772@ifset MIPS
7773@ifclear GENERIC
7774@raisesections
7775@end ifclear
7776
7777@node MIPS
7778@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7779
7780@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7781@kindex --insn32
7782@kindex --no-insn32
7783The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7784microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7785in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation.  If @samp{--insn32} is
7786used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings.  By default
7787or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7788including 16-bit ones where possible.
7789
7790@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7791@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7792@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7793The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7794control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions.  If
7795@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7796relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7797calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7798relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7799instructions as the associated relocation is calculated.  By default
7800or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7801the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7802
7803@ifclear GENERIC
7804@lowersections
7805@end ifclear
7806@end ifset
7807
7808@ifset MMIX
7809@ifclear GENERIC
7810@raisesections
7811@end ifclear
7812
7813@node MMIX
7814@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7815For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7816@code{mmo} object files when linking.  The simulator @code{mmix}
7817understands the @code{mmo} format.  The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7818can translate between the two formats.
7819
7820There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7821Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7822registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7823equal to registers.  In a final link, the start address of the
7824@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7825global register multiplied by 8.  Register @code{$255} is not included in
7826this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7827symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7828
7829Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7830@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7831The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7832of a section.
7833
7834Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7835are left out from an mmo file.
7836
7837@ifclear GENERIC
7838@lowersections
7839@end ifclear
7840@end ifset
7841
7842@ifset MSP430
7843@ifclear GENERIC
7844@raisesections
7845@end ifclear
7846
7847@node  MSP430
7848@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7849For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture.  The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7850will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type.  (To get a list of known MPUs
7851just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7852
7853@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7854The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7855
7856@table @code
7857@item @samp{.vectors}
7858Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7859
7860@item @samp{.bootloader}
7861Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable).  Any code
7862in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7863
7864@item @samp{.infomem}
7865Defines an information memory section (if applicable).  Any code in
7866this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7867
7868@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7869This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7870in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7871
7872@item @samp{.noinit}
7873Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7874
7875The last two sections are used by gcc.
7876@end table
7877
7878@table @option
7879@cindex MSP430 Options
7880@kindex --code-region
7881@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7882This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7883argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7884using this option.
7885
7886@kindex --data-region
7887@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7888This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7889[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7890for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7891
7892@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7893@item --disable-sec-transformation
7894Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7895and @code{--data-region} options.
7896This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7897wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7898not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7899@end table
7900
7901@ifclear GENERIC
7902@lowersections
7903@end ifclear
7904@end ifset
7905
7906@ifset NDS32
7907@ifclear GENERIC
7908@raisesections
7909@end ifclear
7910
7911@node NDS32
7912@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7913@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7914For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior.  The linker
7915relaxes objects according to these options.
7916
7917@table @code
7918@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7919Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7920
7921@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7922Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7923
7924@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7925Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7926
7927@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7928Export the EX9 table after linking.
7929
7930@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7931Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7932
7933@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7934Update the existing EX9 table.
7935
7936@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7937Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7938
7939@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7940Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7941
7942@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7943Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7944
7945@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7946Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7947@end table
7948
7949@ifclear GENERIC
7950@lowersections
7951@end ifclear
7952@end ifset
7953
7954@ifset NIOSII
7955@ifclear GENERIC
7956@raisesections
7957@end ifclear
7958
7959@node Nios II
7960@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7961@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7962@kindex --relax on Nios II
7963
7964Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7965transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7966which may result in @command{ld} giving
7967@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7968The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7969trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7970outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range.  These
7971trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7972be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7973larger than 256MB.
7974
7975The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7976is also specified.  You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7977@option{--no-relax} linker option.  You can also disable this optimization
7978locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7979source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7980register as a temporary.
7981
7982Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7983relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7984option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7985
7986@ifclear GENERIC
7987@lowersections
7988@end ifclear
7989@end ifset
7990
7991@ifset POWERPC
7992@ifclear GENERIC
7993@raisesections
7994@end ifclear
7995
7996@node PowerPC ELF32
7997@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7998@cindex PowerPC long branches
7999@kindex --relax on PowerPC
8000Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8001displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8002@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8003@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8004the entire 32-bit address space.  These trampolines are inserted at
8005section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
8006section exceeds 33M in size.  You may combine @samp{-r} and
8007@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link.  In that case
8008both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8009considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
8010
8011@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8012@table @option
8013@cindex PowerPC PLT
8014@kindex --bss-plt
8015@item --bss-plt
8016Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8017generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8018the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8019writable and no writable section ever being executable.  PowerPC
8020@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8021PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8022compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}.  @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8023BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8024
8025@kindex --secure-plt
8026@item --secure-plt
8027@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8028@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8029when linking non-PIC code.  This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8030layout.  A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8031style BSS PLT.
8032
8033@cindex PowerPC GOT
8034@kindex --sdata-got
8035@item --sdata-got
8036The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8037sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement.  The location of
8038@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8039section while the old PLT is uninitialized.  The reason for the
8040@code{.got} change is more subtle:  The new placement allows
8041@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8042@samp{-z relro -z now}.  However, this placement means that
8043@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8044PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8045pointer.  @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement.  PowerPC
8046GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8047really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8048
8049@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8050@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8051@item --emit-stub-syms
8052This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8053symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8054
8055@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8056@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8057@item --no-tls-optimize
8058PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8059sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage.  Use this option to
8060disable the optimization.
8061@end table
8062
8063@ifclear GENERIC
8064@lowersections
8065@end ifclear
8066@end ifset
8067
8068@ifset POWERPC64
8069@ifclear GENERIC
8070@raisesections
8071@end ifclear
8072
8073@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8074@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8075
8076@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8077@table @option
8078@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8079@kindex --stub-group-size
8080@item --stub-group-size
8081Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs  and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8082by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8083@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8084sections handled by one stub section.  Since branch offsets are signed,
8085a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8086the stub section, and one group after it.  However, when using
8087conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8088prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8089A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8090branches to stubs always use a negative offset.  Two special values of
8091@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}.  These both instruct
8092@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8093detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8094positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8095
8096Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections.  A
8097single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8098create a larger group (of one section).  If input sections are too
8099large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8100
8101@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8102@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8103@item --emit-stub-syms
8104This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8105symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8106
8107@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8108@kindex --dotsyms
8109@kindex --no-dotsyms
8110@item --dotsyms
8111@itemx --no-dotsyms
8112These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8113in a version script.  Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8114function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8115code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}).  To
8116properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8117to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}.  The option
8118@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8119dot-prefixed patterns.  Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8120feature.
8121
8122@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8123@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8124@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8125@item --save-restore-funcs
8126@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8127These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8128provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8129@samp{-Os} code.  The default is to provide any such referenced
8130function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8131link.
8132
8133@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8134@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8135@item --no-tls-optimize
8136PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8137sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage.  Use this option to
8138disable the optimization.
8139
8140@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8141@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8142@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8143@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8144@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8145@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8146@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8147These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8148stub to call __tls_get_addr.  PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8149an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8150@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8151stub without calling in to glibc.  By default the linker enables
8152generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8153__tls_get_addr_opt.
8154Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8155much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8156an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8157will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8158@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8159and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc.  Normally,
8160this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8161Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8162@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8163register saves.
8164
8165@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8166@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8167@item --no-opd-optimize
8168PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8169corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8170the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8171Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8172
8173@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8174@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8175@item --non-overlapping-opd
8176Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8177@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8178the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8179entry.  This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8180
8181@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8182@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8183@item --no-toc-optimize
8184PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8185entries.  Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8186reference the TOC in code sections.  A reloc in a deleted code section
8187marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8188marks a TOC word as needed.  Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8189relocs are also examined.  TOC words marked as both needed and
8190unneeded will of course be kept.  TOC words without any referencing
8191reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8192discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word.  This works
8193reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8194code is used to insert TOC entries.  Use this option to disable the
8195optimization.
8196
8197@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8198@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8199@item --no-inline-optimize
8200PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8201marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8202@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8203a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8204locally and can't be overridden by some other definition.  This option
8205disables that optimization.
8206
8207@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8208@kindex --no-multi-toc
8209@item --no-multi-toc
8210If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8211@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8212where TOC
8213entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2.  This limits the
8214total TOC size to 64K.  PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8215grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8216TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8217calls.  @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8218help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
821964K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8220Use this option to turn off this feature.
8221
8222@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8223@kindex --no-toc-sort
8224@item --no-toc-sort
8225By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8226happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8227placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8228with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8229referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8230@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options.  Doing this
8231results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC.  Use this option to turn
8232off this feature.
8233
8234@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8235@kindex --plt-align
8236@kindex --no-plt-align
8237@item --plt-align
8238@itemx --no-plt-align
8239Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8240aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8241boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}.  A negative value may be
8242specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8243specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8244if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary).  By default
8245PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8246
8247@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8248@kindex --plt-static-chain
8249@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8250@item --plt-static-chain
8251@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8252Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8253chain pointer (r11).  @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8254chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8255
8256@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8257@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8258@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8259@item --plt-thread-safe
8260@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8261With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8262lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8263another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8264order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8265memory write barriers.  To avoid this we need some sort of read
8266barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1.  By default, @code{ld}
8267looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8268seen, adds the necessary barriers.  Use these options to change the
8269default behaviour.
8270
8271@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8272@kindex --plt-localentry
8273@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8274@item --plt-localentry
8275@itemx --no-localentry
8276ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8277ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8278(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8279Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8280or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8281functions.   The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8282in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8283interposition failures.  Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8284including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8285to become localentry:8.  This will result in a dynamic loader
8286complaint and failure to run.  The option is experimental, use with
8287care.  @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8288
8289@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8290@kindex --power10-stubs
8291@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8292@item --power10-stubs
8293@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8294When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8295relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8296linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8297for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known.  The
8298power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8299power10.  @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8300allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8301@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8302auto mode.
8303@end table
8304
8305@ifclear GENERIC
8306@lowersections
8307@end ifclear
8308@end ifset
8309
8310@ifset S/390
8311@ifclear GENERIC
8312@raisesections
8313@end ifclear
8314
8315@node S/390 ELF
8316@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8317
8318@cindex S/390 ELF options
8319@table @option
8320
8321@cindex S/390
8322@kindex --s390-pgste
8323@item --s390-pgste
8324This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8325segment.  The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8326binaries marked that way.
8327@end table
8328
8329@ifclear GENERIC
8330@lowersections
8331@end ifclear
8332@end ifset
8333
8334@ifset SPU
8335@ifclear GENERIC
8336@raisesections
8337@end ifclear
8338
8339@node SPU ELF
8340@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8341
8342@cindex SPU ELF options
8343@table @option
8344
8345@cindex SPU plugins
8346@kindex --plugin
8347@item --plugin
8348This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8349
8350@cindex SPU overlays
8351@kindex --no-overlays
8352@item --no-overlays
8353Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8354regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8355@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager.  This option
8356turns off all this special overlay handling.
8357
8358@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8359@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8360@item --emit-stub-syms
8361This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8362symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8363
8364@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8365@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8366@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8367This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8368function calls out of overlay regions.  Normally stubs are not added
8369on calls to non-overlay regions.
8370
8371@cindex SPU local store size
8372@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8373@item --local-store=lo:hi
8374@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8375the address range 0 to 256k.  This option may be used to change the
8376range.  Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8377
8378@cindex SPU
8379@kindex --stack-analysis
8380@item --stack-analysis
8381SPU local store space is limited.  Over-allocation of stack space
8382unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8383under-allocation results in runtime failures.  If given this option,
8384@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8385@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8386determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8387for stack adjusting instructions.  A call-graph is created by looking
8388for relocations on branch instructions.  The graph is then searched
8389for the maximum stack usage path.  Note that this analysis does not
8390find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8391and other cycles in the call graph.  Stack usage may be
8392under-estimated if your code makes such calls.  Also, stack usage for
8393dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected.  If a link map
8394is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8395and calls will be given.
8396
8397@cindex SPU
8398@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8399@item --emit-stack-syms
8400This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8401in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8402These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8403functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8404functions.  @code{<number>} is the section id in hex.  The value of
8405such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8406The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8407@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8408@end table
8409
8410@ifclear GENERIC
8411@lowersections
8412@end ifclear
8413@end ifset
8414
8415@ifset TICOFF
8416@ifclear GENERIC
8417@raisesections
8418@end ifclear
8419
8420@node TI COFF
8421@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8422@cindex TI COFF versions
8423@kindex --format=@var{version}
8424The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8425TI COFF versions.  The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8426also supported.  The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8427format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8428header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8429
8430@ifclear GENERIC
8431@lowersections
8432@end ifclear
8433@end ifset
8434
8435@ifset WIN32
8436@ifclear GENERIC
8437@raisesections
8438@end ifclear
8439
8440@node WIN32
8441@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8442
8443This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8444See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8445command-line options mentioned here.
8446
8447@table @emph
8448@cindex import libraries
8449@item import libraries
8450The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8451libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's.  They are
8452regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8453archive.  The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8454support for creating such libraries provided with the
8455@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8456
8457@item   exporting DLL symbols
8458@cindex exporting DLL symbols
8459The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8460
8461@table @emph
8462@item   using auto-export functionality
8463@cindex using auto-export functionality
8464By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8465which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8466
8467@itemize
8468@item --export-all-symbols   [This is the default]
8469@item --exclude-symbols
8470@item --exclude-libs
8471@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8472@item --version-script
8473@end itemize
8474
8475When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8476(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8477symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries.  As it will
8478often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8479private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8480options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8481exporting.  The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8482final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8483
8484If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8485command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8486if either of the following are true:
8487
8488@itemize
8489@item A DEF file is used.
8490@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8491@end itemize
8492
8493@item   using a DEF file
8494@cindex using a DEF file
8495Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file.  A DEF file is
8496an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8497exported when a dll is created.  Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8498name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8499command line.  The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8500
8501@example
8502gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8503@end example
8504
8505Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8506@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8507
8508Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8509
8510@example
8511LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8512
8513EXPORTS
8514foo
8515bar
8516_bar = bar
8517another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8518var1 DATA
8519doo = foo == foo2
8520eoo DATA == var1
8521@end example
8522
8523This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8524symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8525alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8526by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8527@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8528@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8529export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8530in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8531symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8532
8533The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8534name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8535the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8536
8537When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8538library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8539@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8540executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8541
8542With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8543specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8544non-default base address for the image.
8545
8546If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor  @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8547or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8548filename specified on the command line.
8549
8550The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8551
8552@example
8553EXPORTS
8554  ( (  ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8555     | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8556  [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8557@end example
8558
8559Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8560@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8561@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8562@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8563Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8564@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8565string in import/export table for the symbol.
8566
8567The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8568
8569@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table.  It
8570will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8571by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8572linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8573library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8574
8575@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8576The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8577the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8578@code{*_imp__foo}).
8579
8580@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8581well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8582read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8583variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8584the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8585extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8586application will behave unexpectedly.
8587
8588@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8589it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8590symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8591API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8592the DLL without an import library.
8593
8594See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8595other DEF file statements
8596
8597@cindex creating a DEF file
8598While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8599with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8600
8601@item   Using decorations
8602@cindex Using decorations
8603Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8604itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8605declared as:
8606
8607@example
8608__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8609__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8610@end example
8611
8612All such symbols will be exported from the DLL.  If, however,
8613any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8614this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8615the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8616
8617Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8618decorate them with dllexport.  Instead, they should use dllimport,
8619instead:
8620
8621@example
8622__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8623__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8624@end example
8625
8626This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8627when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8628variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8629code the header must declare them as dllimport.  There are a number
8630of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8631omit the __declspec() declaration completely.  See
8632@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8633information.
8634@end table
8635
8636@cindex automatic data imports
8637@item automatic data imports
8638The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8639by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8640compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8641issue.  This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8642code to these platforms, especially for large
8643c++ libraries and applications.  The auto-import feature, which was
8644initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8645decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8646platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8647command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8648The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8649suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8650trigger the feature's use.
8651
8652auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8653additional assistance.  Sometimes, you will see this message
8654
8655"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8656documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8657
8658The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8659occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8660One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8661below.
8662
8663@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8664For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8665object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8666offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8667field or public member, for instance.  Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8668in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8669without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8670The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8671references.
8672
8673The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8674be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8675themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8676runtime environment.  Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8677compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not.  However, the
8678support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8679run without error on an older system.
8680
8681@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8682enabled as needed.
8683
8684@cindex direct linking to a dll
8685@item direct linking to a dll
8686The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8687including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8688libraries.  This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8689traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8690libraries or applications.  When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8691function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8692though a single bfd could contain many exports.  The overhead involved in
8693storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8694tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8695large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8696
8697Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8698@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8699of names to match each library.  All that is needed from the developer's
8700perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8701select the dll instead of an import library.
8702
8703
8704For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8705to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8706
8707@example
8708libxxx.dll.a
8709xxx.dll.a
8710libxxx.a
8711xxx.lib
8712libxxx.lib
8713cygxxx.dll (*)
8714libxxx.dll
8715xxx.dll
8716@end example
8717
8718before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8719
8720(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8721where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8722@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8723file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8724@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8725
8726Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8727@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature.  It
8728was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8729various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8730could coexist on the same machine.
8731
8732The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8733applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8734libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8735
8736@example
8737bin/
8738	cygxxx.dll
8739lib/
8740	libxxx.dll.a   (in case of dll's)
8741	libxxx.a       (in case of static archive)
8742@end example
8743
8744Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8745done two ways:
8746
87471. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8748@example
8749gcc -Wl,-verbose  -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8750@end example
8751
8752However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8753(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8754@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version.  Import libs are generally
8755not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8756
87572. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8758directory according to the above mentioned search pattern.  This
8759should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8760making the app/dll.
8761
8762@example
8763ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8764@end example
8765
8766Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8767
8768@example
8769gcc -Wl,-verbose  -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8770@end example
8771
8772This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8773perfectly legal
8774
8775@example
8776bin/
8777	cygxxx-5.dll
8778lib/
8779	libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8780@end example
8781
8782Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8783even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8784@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8785
8786Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8787wonder why import libraries are used at all.  There are three reasons:
8788
87891. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8790work with auto-imported data.
8791
87922. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8793import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8794symbols that point to the exports of a dll).  Again, the import lib
8795for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8796possible to do this without an import lib.
8797
87983. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib.  This is
8799critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8800in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8801stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8802
8803So, import libs are not going away.  But the ability to replace
8804true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8805a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8806binutils makes available to the win32 developer.  Given the
8807massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8808requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8809will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8810
8811@item symbol aliasing
8812@table @emph
8813@item adding additional names
8814Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8815A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8816exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8817when creating the dll.  This will affect also the optional created
8818import library.  Consider the following DEF file:
8819
8820@example
8821LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8822
8823EXPORTS
8824foo
8825_foo = foo
8826@end example
8827
8828The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8829
8830Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8831source code using the "weak" attribute:
8832
8833@example
8834void foo () @{ /* Do something.  */; @}
8835void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8836@end example
8837
8838See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8839symbols.
8840
8841@item renaming symbols
8842Sometimes it is useful to rename exports.  For instance, the cygwin
8843kernel does this regularly.  A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8844@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8845DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8846created).  In the following example:
8847
8848@example
8849LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8850
8851EXPORTS
8852_foo = foo
8853@end example
8854
8855The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8856@samp{_foo}.
8857@end table
8858
8859Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8860unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8861If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8862@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8863that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8864@samp{--export-all-symbols} option.  If you list only the
8865renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8866to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8867the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8868In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8869which is probably not what you wanted.
8870
8871@cindex weak externals
8872@item weak externals
8873The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8874weak externals.  When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8875defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol.  There
8876are three variants of weak externals:
8877@itemize
8878@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8879called lazy externals.
8880@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8881This form is not presently implemented.
8882@item No search; the symbol is an alias.  This form is not presently
8883implemented.
8884@end itemize
8885As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8886are supported.  If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8887uses a default value.
8888
8889@cindex aligned common symbols
8890@item aligned common symbols
8891As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8892desired alignment for a common symbol.  This information is conveyed from
8893the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8894carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8895by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols.  Native
8896tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8897but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8898warnings about unknown linker directives.
8899
8900@end table
8901
8902@ifclear GENERIC
8903@lowersections
8904@end ifclear
8905@end ifset
8906
8907@ifset XTENSA
8908@ifclear GENERIC
8909@raisesections
8910@end ifclear
8911
8912@node Xtensa
8913@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8914
8915@cindex Xtensa processors
8916The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8917@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8918specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8919keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets.  For
8920example, with the command:
8921
8922@smallexample
8923SECTIONS
8924@{
8925  .text : @{
8926    *(.literal .text)
8927  @}
8928@}
8929@end smallexample
8930
8931@noindent
8932@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8933and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8934literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets.  A valid
8935interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8936group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8937files.  Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8938and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8939
8940@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8941@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8942Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8943provides two important link-time optimizations.  The first optimization
8944is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size.  A redundant
8945literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8946will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8947location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8948the @code{L32R} instructions.  The second optimization is to remove
8949unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8950@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8951range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8952
8953For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8954to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8955instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8956instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8957instruction if it is not used for anything else.  Removing the
8958@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8959hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8960By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8961switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8962density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8963instruction that was removed.  If code size is more important than
8964performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8965linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8966a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8967
8968The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8969control the linker:
8970
8971@cindex Xtensa options
8972@table @option
8973@item --size-opt
8974When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8975more than performance.  With this option, the linker will not insert
8976no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8977alignment.  There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8978preserve the correctness of the code.
8979
8980@item --abi-windowed
8981@itemx --abi-call0
8982Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8983PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8984because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8985conventions.
8986Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8987of the first input object.
8988A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8989or the chosen output object ABI.
8990@end table
8991
8992@ifclear GENERIC
8993@lowersections
8994@end ifclear
8995@end ifset
8996
8997@ifclear SingleFormat
8998@node BFD
8999@chapter BFD
9000
9001@cindex back end
9002@cindex object file management
9003@cindex object formats available
9004@kindex objdump -i
9005The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9006These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9007object files whatever the object file format.  A different object file
9008format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9009it to the library.  To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9010associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9011object file formats available.  You can use @code{objdump -i}
9012(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9013list all the formats available for your configuration.
9014
9015@cindex BFD requirements
9016@cindex requirements for BFD
9017As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9018several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9019BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9020formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9021been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9022BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9023may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9024
9025One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9026mind is the potential for information loss.  There are two places where
9027useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9028conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9029
9030@menu
9031* BFD outline::                 How it works: an outline of BFD
9032@end menu
9033
9034@node BFD outline
9035@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
9036@cindex opening object files
9037@include bfdsumm.texi
9038@end ifclear
9039
9040@node Reporting Bugs
9041@chapter Reporting Bugs
9042@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9043@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
9044
9045Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
9046
9047Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9048it may not.  But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
9049to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
9050work better.  Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
9051@command{ld}.
9052
9053In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9054information that enables us to fix the bug.
9055
9056@menu
9057* Bug Criteria::                Have you found a bug?
9058* Bug Reporting::               How to report bugs
9059@end menu
9060
9061@node Bug Criteria
9062@section Have You Found a Bug?
9063@cindex bug criteria
9064
9065If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9066
9067@itemize @bullet
9068@cindex fatal signal
9069@cindex linker crash
9070@cindex crash of linker
9071@item
9072If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9073@command{ld} bug.  Reliable linkers never crash.
9074
9075@cindex error on valid input
9076@item
9077If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9078
9079@cindex invalid input
9080@item
9081If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9082may be a bug.  In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9083object files are correct.
9084
9085@item
9086If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9087improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9088@end itemize
9089
9090@node Bug Reporting
9091@section How to Report Bugs
9092@cindex bug reports
9093@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9094
9095A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9096products.  If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9097recommend you contact that organization first.
9098
9099You can find contact information for many support companies and
9100individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9101distribution.
9102
9103@ifset BUGURL
9104Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9105@value{BUGURL}.
9106@end ifset
9107
9108The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9109@strong{report all the facts}.  If you are not sure whether to state a
9110fact or leave it out, state it!
9111
9112Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9113problem and assume that some details do not matter.  Thus, you might
9114assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9115matter.  Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure.  Perhaps
9116the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9117location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9118were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9119into doing the right thing despite the bug.  Play it safe and give a
9120specific, complete example.  That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9121and the most helpful.
9122
9123Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9124the bug if it is new to us.  Therefore, always write your bug reports
9125on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9126
9127Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9128bell?''  This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless.  We
9129respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9130You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9131
9132To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9133
9134@itemize @bullet
9135@item
9136The version of @command{ld}.  @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9137the @samp{--version} argument.
9138
9139Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9140the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9141
9142@item
9143Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9144patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9145
9146@item
9147The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9148version number.
9149
9150@item
9151What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9152``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9153
9154@item
9155The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9156observe the bug.  To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9157list them all.  A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9158sufficient.
9159
9160If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9161and then we might not encounter the bug.
9162
9163@item
9164A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9165bug.  It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9166provided that they are reasonably small.  Say no more than 10K.  For
9167bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9168state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9169requests them.  (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9170we do not want to clog it up with large attachments).  But small
9171attachments are best.
9172
9173If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9174@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9175object files.  In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9176@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files.  Also say
9177how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9178
9179@item
9180A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9181incorrect.  For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9182
9183Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9184will certainly notice it.  But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9185not notice unless it is glaringly wrong.  You might as well not give us
9186a chance to make a mistake.
9187
9188Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9189say so explicitly.  Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9190copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9191C library on your system.  (This has happened!)  Your copy might crash
9192and ours would not.  If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9193fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us.  If
9194you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9195any conclusion from our observations.
9196
9197@item
9198If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9199diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9200@samp{-p} option.  Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9201If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9202context, not by line number.
9203
9204The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9205sources.  Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9206@end itemize
9207
9208Here are some things that are not necessary:
9209
9210@itemize @bullet
9211@item
9212A description of the envelope of the bug.
9213
9214Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9215which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9216changes will not affect it.
9217
9218This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9219will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9220with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9221We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9222
9223Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9224of the original one, that is a convenience for us.  Errors in the
9225output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9226less time, and so on.
9227
9228However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9229report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9230
9231@item
9232A patch for the bug.
9233
9234A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one.  But do not omit
9235the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9236a patch is all we need.  We might see problems with your patch and decide
9237to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9238
9239Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9240construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9241through the code.  If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9242able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9243fixed.
9244
9245And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9246patch should be an improvement, we will not install it.  A test case will
9247help us to understand.
9248
9249@item
9250A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9251
9252Such guesses are usually wrong.  Even we cannot guess right about such
9253things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9254@end itemize
9255
9256@node MRI
9257@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9258@cindex MRI compatibility
9259To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9260linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9261alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9262described in @ref{Scripts}.  MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9263simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9264@command{ld}.  @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9265linker commands; these commands are described here.
9266
9267In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9268file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9269features to make use of them.
9270
9271You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9272@samp{-c} command-line option.
9273
9274Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9275command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9276blank lines are also allowed for punctuation).  If a line of an
9277MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9278issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9279
9280Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9281
9282You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9283lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9284The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9285
9286@table @code
9287@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9288@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9289@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9290Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9291the input files.  However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9292@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9293your output program.  If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9294script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9295commands will appear in the linker output.  You can still use other
9296input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9297@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9298
9299@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9300@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9301Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9302in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9303
9304@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9305
9306@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9307@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9308Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}.  The
9309@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9310
9311@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9312@item BASE @var{expression}
9313Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9314absolute addresses) in the output file.
9315
9316@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9317@item CHIP @var{expression}
9318@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9319This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9320
9321@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9322@item END
9323This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9324
9325@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9326@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9327Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9328language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9329
9330@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9331@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9332Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9333@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9334
9335The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9336same line, with no change in its effect.
9337
9338@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9339@item LOAD @var{filename}
9340@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9341Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9342same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9343command line.
9344
9345@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9346@item NAME @var{output-name}
9347@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9348MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9349option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9350
9351@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9352@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9353@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9354Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9355order in which they first appear in the input files.  In an MRI-compatible
9356script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command.  The
9357sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9358file, in the order specified.
9359
9360@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9361@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9362@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9363@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9364Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9365@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9366
9367@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9368@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9369@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9370@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9371You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9372specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9373If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9374@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9375@end table
9376
9377@node GNU Free Documentation License
9378@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9379@include fdl.texi
9380
9381@node LD Index
9382@unnumbered LD Index
9383
9384@printindex cp
9385
9386@tex
9387% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo.  In the
9388% meantime:
9389\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9390\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9391\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9392\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9393\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9394\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9395\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9396\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9397\page\colophon
9398% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9399@end tex
9400
9401@bye
9402